blob: c88592a720dcd4b5fd8cac3bd45da81da613b5b3 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
2 HAProxy
3 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau21475e32010-05-23 08:46:08 +02005 version 1.5
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreaua3ecbd92012-12-28 15:04:05 +01007 2012/12/28
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
11specified above. It does not provide any hint, example or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013The summary below is meant to help you search sections by name and navigate
14through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
22 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to help get the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when it can become ambiguous. If you add sections,
25 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
341.2.1. The Request line
351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
371.3.1. The Response line
381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
422.2. Time format
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200432.3. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020044
453. Global parameters
463.1. Process management and security
473.2. Performance tuning
483.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100493.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200503.5. Peers
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020051
524. Proxies
534.1. Proxy keywords matrix
544.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
55
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200565. Bind and Server options
575.1. Bind options
585.2. Server and default-server options
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020059
606. HTTP header manipulation
61
Cyril Bonté7d38afb2010-02-03 20:41:26 +0100627. Using ACLs and pattern extraction
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200637.1. Matching integers
647.2. Matching strings
657.3. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +0200667.4. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200677.5. Available matching criteria
687.5.1. Matching at Layer 4 and below
697.5.2. Matching contents at Layer 4
707.5.3. Matching at Layer 7
717.6. Pre-defined ACLs
727.7. Using ACLs to form conditions
Cyril Bonté7d38afb2010-02-03 20:41:26 +0100737.8. Pattern extraction
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020074
758. Logging
768.1. Log levels
778.2. Log formats
788.2.1. Default log format
798.2.2. TCP log format
808.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100818.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +0100828.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200838.3. Advanced logging options
848.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
858.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
868.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
878.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
888.4. Timing events
898.5. Session state at disconnection
908.6. Non-printable characters
918.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
928.8. Capturing HTTP headers
938.9. Examples of logs
94
959. Statistics and monitoring
969.1. CSV format
979.2. Unix Socket commands
98
99
1001. Quick reminder about HTTP
101----------------------------
102
103When haproxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
104fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
105on almost anything found in the contents.
106
107However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
108formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
109correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
110
111
1121.1. The HTTP transaction model
113-------------------------------
114
115The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100116to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200117from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client on the
118connection, the server responds and the connection is closed. A new request
119will involve a new connection :
120
121 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
122
123In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
124establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
125by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
126length.
127
128Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
129to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
130however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
131response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
132header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
133
134 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
135
136Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
137power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
138but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200139a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200140
141A last improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
142keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
143second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
144page :
145
146 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
147
148This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
149latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
150correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
151the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100152server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200153
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200154By default HAProxy operates in a tunnel-like mode with regards to persistent
155connections: for each connection it processes the first request and forwards
156everything else (including additional requests) to selected server. Once
157established, the connection is persisted both on the client and server
158sides. Use "option http-server-close" to preserve client persistent connections
159while handling every incoming request individually, dispatching them one after
160another to servers, in HTTP close mode. Use "option httpclose" to switch both
161sides to HTTP close mode. "option forceclose" and "option
162http-pretend-keepalive" help working around servers misbehaving in HTTP close
163mode.
164
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200165
1661.2. HTTP request
167-----------------
168
169First, let's consider this HTTP request :
170
171 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100172 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200173 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
174 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
175 3 User-agent: my small browser
176 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
177 5 Accept: image/png
178
179
1801.2.1. The Request line
181-----------------------
182
183Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
184
185 - a METHOD : GET
186 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
187 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
188
189All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
190which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
191followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
192is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
193desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
194the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
195
196The URI itself can have several forms :
197
198 - A "relative URI" :
199
200 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
201
202 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
203 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
204
205 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
206
207 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
208
209 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
210 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
211 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
212 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
213 must accept this form too.
214
215 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
216 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
217 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100218
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200219 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
220 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
221 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
222 other protocols too.
223
224In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
225mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
226on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
227It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
228specific to the language, framework or application in use.
229
230
2311.2.2. The request headers
232--------------------------
233
234The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
235beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
236an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
237Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
238values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
239encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
240the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
241define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
242
243Contrary to a common mis-conception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
244their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
245"Connection:" header).
246
247The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
248that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
249is one valid form of empty line.
250
251Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
252headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
253about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
254application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
255
256Important note:
257 As suggested by RFC2616, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
258 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
259 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
260 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
261
262
2631.3. HTTP response
264------------------
265
266An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
267messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
268
269 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100270 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200271 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
272 2 Content-length: 350
273 3 Content-Type: text/html
274
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200275As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
276codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
277response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100278continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
279the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
280following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
281sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
282(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
283correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
284such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
285state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
286over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
287if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
288information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200289
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200290
2911.3.1. The Response line
292------------------------
293
294Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
295
296 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
297 - a status code : 200
298 - a reason : OK
299
300The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200301 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (eg: 100, 101)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200302 - 2xx = OK, content is following (eg: 200, 206)
303 - 3xx = OK, no content following (eg: 302, 304)
304 - 4xx = error caused by the client (eg: 401, 403, 404)
305 - 5xx = error caused by the server (eg: 500, 502, 503)
306
307Please refer to RFC2616 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100308"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200309found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
310messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
311or "Authentication Required".
312
313Haproxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
314
315 Code When / reason
316 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
317 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
318 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
319 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
320 400 for an invalid or too large request
321 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
322 accessing the stats page)
323 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
324 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
325 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
326 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
327 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
328 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
329 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
330 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
331 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
332
333The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3344.2).
335
336
3371.3.2. The response headers
338---------------------------
339
340Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
341the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
342details.
343
344
3452. Configuring HAProxy
346----------------------
347
3482.1. Configuration file format
349------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200350
351HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
352
353 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
354 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
355 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
356 "frontend" and "backend".
357
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100358The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
359referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
360delimited by spaces. If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100361preceded by a backslash ('\') to be escaped. Backslashes also have to be
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100362escaped by doubling them.
363
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200364
3652.2. Time format
366----------------
367
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100368Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100369values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
370otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
371numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
372for every keyword. Supported units are :
373
374 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
375 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
376 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
377 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
378 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
379 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
380
381
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +02003822.3. Examples
383-------------
384
385 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
386 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
387 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
388 global
389 daemon
390 maxconn 256
391
392 defaults
393 mode http
394 timeout connect 5000ms
395 timeout client 50000ms
396 timeout server 50000ms
397
398 frontend http-in
399 bind *:80
400 default_backend servers
401
402 backend servers
403 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
404
405
406 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
407 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
408 global
409 daemon
410 maxconn 256
411
412 defaults
413 mode http
414 timeout connect 5000ms
415 timeout client 50000ms
416 timeout server 50000ms
417
418 listen http-in
419 bind *:80
420 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
421
422
423Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
424
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100425 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200426
427
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004283. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200429--------------------
430
431Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
432are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
433of them have command-line equivalents.
434
435The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
436
437 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200438 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200439 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200440 - crt-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200441 - daemon
442 - gid
443 - group
444 - log
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100445 - log-send-hostname
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200446 - nbproc
447 - pidfile
448 - uid
449 - ulimit-n
450 - user
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200451 - stats
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200452 - node
453 - description
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100454 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100455
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200456 * Performance tuning
457 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200458 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100459 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100460 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100461 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200462 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200463 - noepoll
464 - nokqueue
465 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100466 - nosplice
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200467 - spread-checks
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200468 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200469 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100470 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100471 - tune.http.cookielen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200472 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100473 - tune.maxaccept
474 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200475 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200476 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100477 - tune.rcvbuf.client
478 - tune.rcvbuf.server
479 - tune.sndbuf.client
480 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100481 - tune.ssl.cachesize
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100482 - tune.zlib.memlevel
483 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100484
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200485 * Debugging
486 - debug
487 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200488
489
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004903.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200491------------------------------------
492
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200493ca-base <dir>
494 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200495 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
496 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200497
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200498chroot <jail dir>
499 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
500 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
501 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
502 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
503 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
504 empty and unwritable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100505
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100506cpu-map <"all"|"odd"|"even"|process_num> <cpu-set>...
507 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process to a specific CPU
508 set. This means that the process will never run on other CPUs. The "cpu-map"
509 directive specifies CPU sets for process sets. The first argument is the
510 process number to bind. This process must have a number between 1 and 32,
511 and any process IDs above nbproc are ignored. It is possible to specify all
512 processes at once using "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers
513 using "even", just like with the "bind-process" directive. The second and
514 forthcoming arguments are CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number
515 between 0 and 31 or a range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-').
516 Multiple CPU numbers or ranges may be specified, and the processes will be
517 allowed to bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may
518 be specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace the previous ones when
519 they overlap.
520
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200521crt-base <dir>
522 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
523 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
524 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
525
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200526daemon
527 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
528 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
529 disabled by the command line "-db" argument.
530
531gid <number>
532 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
533 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
534 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100535 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
536 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200537 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100538
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200539group <group name>
540 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
541 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100542
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200543log <address> <facility> [max level [min level]]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200544 Adds a global syslog server. Up to two global servers can be defined. They
545 will receive logs for startups and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100546 configured with "log global".
547
548 <address> can be one of:
549
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100550 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100551 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
552 port).
553
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100554 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
555 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
556 port).
557
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100558 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
559 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
560 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
561 writeable).
562
563 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200564
565 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
566 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
567 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
568
569 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200570 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
571 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
572 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
573 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
574 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
575 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200576
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200577 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200578
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100579log-send-hostname [<string>]
580 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
581 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
582 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
583 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
584 the logs.
585
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000586log-tag <string>
587 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
588 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
589 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
590 running on the same host.
591
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200592nbproc <number>
593 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
594 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
595 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
596 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
597 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon".
598
599pidfile <pidfile>
600 Writes pids of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
601 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
602 starting the process. See also "daemon".
603
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +0100604stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-32>[-<number 1-32>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200605 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
606 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
607 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
608 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
609 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
610 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
611 the number of processes used.
612
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200613stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
614 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
615 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
616 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
617 consult section 9.2 "Unix Socket commands" for more details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200618
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200619 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
620 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
621 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200622
623stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
624 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
625 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +0100626 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200627
628stats maxconn <connections>
629 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
630 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
631
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200632uid <number>
633 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
634 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
635 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
636 one. See also "gid" and "user".
637
638ulimit-n <number>
639 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
640 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
641 option.
642
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100643unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
644 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
645
646 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
647 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
648 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
649 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
650 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
651 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
652 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
653 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
654 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
655 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
656
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200657user <user name>
658 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
659 See also "uid" and "group".
660
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200661node <name>
662 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
663
664 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
665 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
666 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
667 traffic.
668
669description <text>
670 Add a text that describes the instance.
671
672 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
673 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
674 "<" and ">" characters.
675
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200676
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006773.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200678-----------------------
679
680maxconn <number>
681 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
682 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
683 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
684 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n".
685
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200686maxconnrate <number>
687 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
688 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
689 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
690 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
691 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
692 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
693 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
694 fairness.
695
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100696maxcomprate <number>
697 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
698 pers second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
699 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
700 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
701 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
702 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
703 default value.
704
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100705maxcompcpuusage <number>
706 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
707 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
708 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
709 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
710 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
711 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
712 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
713 process down and from introducing high latencies.
714
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100715maxpipes <number>
716 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
717 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
718 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
719 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
720 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
721 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
722
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200723maxsslconn <number>
724 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
725 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
726 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
727 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
728 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
729 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
730 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
731
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +0100732maxzlibmem <number>
733 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
734 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
735 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +0100736 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
737 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
738 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
739
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200740noepoll
741 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
742 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +0100743 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200744
745nokqueue
746 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
747 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
748 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
749
750nopoll
751 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
752 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100753 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +0100754 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue" and "noepoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200755
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100756nosplice
757 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
758 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
759 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100760 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100761 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
762 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
763 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
764 "option splice-response".
765
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200766spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
767 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending health checks to servers at exact
768 intervals, for instance when many logical servers are located on the same
769 physical server. With the help of this parameter, it becomes possible to add
770 some randomness in the check interval between 0 and +/- 50%. A value between
771 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The default value remains at 0.
772
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200773tune.bufsize <number>
774 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
775 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
776 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
777 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
778 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
779 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
780 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
781 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased.
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +0400782 If HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
783 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
784 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway).
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200785
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200786tune.chksize <number>
787 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
788 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
789 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
790 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
791 checks whenever possible.
792
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100793tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
794 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
795 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
796 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
797 this value. The default value is 1.
798
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100799tune.http.cookielen <number>
800 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
801 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
802 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
803 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
804 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
805 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
806 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
807 to change this value.
808
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200809tune.http.maxhdr <number>
810 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
811 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
812 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
813 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
814 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
815 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
816 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. Keep in mind that each
817 new header consumes 32bits of memory for each session, so don't push this
818 limit too high.
819
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100820tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +0100821 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
822 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
823 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
824 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
825 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
826 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
827 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
828 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
829 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
830 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100831
832tune.maxpollevents <number>
833 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
834 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
835 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
836 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
837 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
838
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200839tune.maxrewrite <number>
840 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
841 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
842 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
843 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
844 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
845 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
846 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
847 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
848 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
849 bufsize.
850
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200851tune.pipesize <number>
852 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
853 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
854 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
855 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
856 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
857 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
858
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100859tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
860tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
861 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
862 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
863 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
864 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
865 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
866 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
867 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
868
869tune.sndbuf.client <number>
870tune.sndbuf.server <number>
871 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
872 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
873 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
874 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
875 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
876 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
877 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
878 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
879 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
880 notifying haproxy again.
881
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100882tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +0100883 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
884 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
885 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
886 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block use approximatively
887 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
888 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
889 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
890 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
891 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +0100892 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
893 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100894
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +0100895tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
896 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
897 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 mn). It is important to understand that it
898 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
899 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
900 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
901 being used for too long.
902
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100903tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
904 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
905 defines how much memory should be allocated for the intenal compression
906 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
907 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
908 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
909
910tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
911 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
912 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
913 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
914 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200915
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009163.3. Debugging
917--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200918
919debug
920 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
921 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
922 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
923 system startup.
924
925quiet
926 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
927 line argument "-q".
928
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200929
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01009303.4. Userlists
931--------------
932It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
933http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
934it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
935
936userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100937 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100938 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
939
940group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100941 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100942 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
943 proceeded by "users" keyword.
944
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100945user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
946 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100947 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
948 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100949 evaluated using the crypt(3) function so depending of the system's
950 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example modern Glibc
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100951 based Linux system supports MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512 and of course classic,
952 DES-based method of crypting passwords.
953
954
955 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100956 userlist L1
957 group G1 users tiger,scott
958 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100959
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100960 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
961 user scott insecure-password elgato
962 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100963
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100964 userlist L2
965 group G1
966 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100967
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100968 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
969 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
970 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100971
972 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200973
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200974
9753.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200976----------
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200977It is possible to synchronize server entries in stick tables between several
978haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each instance
979pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. Server IDs are used to
980identify servers remotely, so it is important that configurations look similar
981or at least that the same IDs are forced on each server on all participants.
982Interrupted exchanges are automatically detected and recovered from the last
983known point. In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to
984the new one using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new
985process tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication
986during a reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large
987tables.
988
989peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -0400990 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200991 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
992
993peer <peername> <ip>:<port>
994 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
995 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
996 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
997 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
998 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
999 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
1000
1001 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
1002 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
1003
1004 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
1005 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
1006 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
1007 across all peers.
1008
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001009 Example:
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001010 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001011 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
1012 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
1013 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001014
1015 backend mybackend
1016 mode tcp
1017 balance roundrobin
1018 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
1019 stick on src
1020
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001021 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1022 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001023
1024
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010254. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001026----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001027
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001028Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
1029 - defaults <name>
1030 - frontend <name>
1031 - backend <name>
1032 - listen <name>
1033
1034A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
1035its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
1036section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001037section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001038
1039A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
1040connections.
1041
1042A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
1043to forward incoming connections.
1044
1045A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
1046parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
1047
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001048All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
1049'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
1050case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
1051
1052Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
1053logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
1054proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
1055However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
1056name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
1057
1058Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
1059and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001060bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001061protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
1062modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
1063arbitrary criteria.
1064
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001065
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010664.1. Proxy keywords matrix
1067--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001068
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001069The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
1070limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
1071they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
1072limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001073marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, eg. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001074option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02001075and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
1076with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
1077specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001078
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001079
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001080 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
1081------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1082acl - X X X
1083appsession - - X X
1084backlog X X X -
1085balance X - X X
1086bind - X X -
1087bind-process X X X X
1088block - X X X
1089capture cookie - X X -
1090capture request header - X X -
1091capture response header - X X -
1092clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001093compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001094contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1095cookie X - X X
1096default-server X - X X
1097default_backend X X X -
1098description - X X X
1099disabled X X X X
1100dispatch - - X X
1101enabled X X X X
1102errorfile X X X X
1103errorloc X X X X
1104errorloc302 X X X X
1105-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1106errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001107force-persist - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001108fullconn X - X X
1109grace X X X X
1110hash-type X - X X
1111http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01001112http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02001113http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001114http-request - X X X
1115id - X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001116ignore-persist - X X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02001117log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001118maxconn X X X -
1119mode X X X X
1120monitor fail - X X -
1121monitor-net X X X -
1122monitor-uri X X X -
1123option abortonclose (*) X - X X
1124option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
1125option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
1126option allbackups (*) X - X X
1127option checkcache (*) X - X X
1128option clitcpka (*) X X X -
1129option contstats (*) X X X -
1130option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
1131option dontlognull (*) X X X -
1132option forceclose (*) X X X X
1133-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1134option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02001135option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02001136option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001137option http-server-close (*) X X X X
1138option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
1139option httpchk X - X X
1140option httpclose (*) X X X X
1141option httplog X X X X
1142option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001143option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02001144option ldap-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001145option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
1146option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
1147option logasap (*) X X X -
1148option mysql-check X - X X
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01001149option pgsql-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001150option nolinger (*) X X X X
1151option originalto X X X X
1152option persist (*) X - X X
1153option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02001154option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001155option smtpchk X - X X
1156option socket-stats (*) X X X -
1157option splice-auto (*) X X X X
1158option splice-request (*) X X X X
1159option splice-response (*) X X X X
1160option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
1161option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
1162-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1163option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
1164option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
1165option tcpka X X X X
1166option tcplog X X X X
1167option transparent (*) X - X X
1168persist rdp-cookie X - X X
1169rate-limit sessions X X X -
1170redirect - X X X
1171redisp (deprecated) X - X X
1172redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
1173reqadd - X X X
1174reqallow - X X X
1175reqdel - X X X
1176reqdeny - X X X
1177reqiallow - X X X
1178reqidel - X X X
1179reqideny - X X X
1180reqipass - X X X
1181reqirep - X X X
1182reqisetbe - X X X
1183reqitarpit - X X X
1184reqpass - X X X
1185reqrep - X X X
1186-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1187reqsetbe - X X X
1188reqtarpit - X X X
1189retries X - X X
1190rspadd - X X X
1191rspdel - X X X
1192rspdeny - X X X
1193rspidel - X X X
1194rspideny - X X X
1195rspirep - X X X
1196rsprep - X X X
1197server - - X X
1198source X - X X
1199srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02001200stats admin - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001201stats auth X - X X
1202stats enable X - X X
1203stats hide-version X - X X
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02001204stats http-request - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001205stats realm X - X X
1206stats refresh X - X X
1207stats scope X - X X
1208stats show-desc X - X X
1209stats show-legends X - X X
1210stats show-node X - X X
1211stats uri X - X X
1212-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1213stick match - - X X
1214stick on - - X X
1215stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02001216stick store-response - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001217stick-table - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02001218tcp-request connection - X X -
1219tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02001220tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02001221tcp-response content - - X X
1222tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001223timeout check X - X X
1224timeout client X X X -
1225timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
1226timeout connect X - X X
1227timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1228timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
1229timeout http-request X X X X
1230timeout queue X - X X
1231timeout server X - X X
1232timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1233timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02001234timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001235transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01001236unique-id-format X X X -
1237unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001238use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02001239use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001240------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1241 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001242
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001243
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012444.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
1245---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001246
1247This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
1248
1249
1250acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
1251 Declare or complete an access list.
1252 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1253 no | yes | yes | yes
1254 Example:
1255 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1256 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1257 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1258
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001259 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001260
1261
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001262appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
1263 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001264 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
1265 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1266 no | no | yes | yes
1267 Arguments :
1268 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
1269 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
1270
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001271 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001272 checked in each cookie value.
1273
1274 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
1275 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
1276 milliseconds.
1277
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02001278 request-learn
1279 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
1280 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
1281 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
1282 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
1283 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
1284 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
1285
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001286 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
1287 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
1288 data following this prefix.
1289
1290 Example :
1291 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
1292
1293 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXXX=XXXXX,
1294 the appsession value will be XXXX=XXXXX.
1295
1296 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
1297 2 modes are currently supported :
1298 - path-parameters :
1299 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
1300 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
1301 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
1302 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
1303 - query-string :
1304 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
1305 query string.
1306
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001307 When an application cookie is defined in a backend, HAProxy will check when
1308 the server sets such a cookie, and will store its value in a table, and
1309 associate it with the server's identifier. Up to <length> characters from
1310 the value will be retained. On each connection, haproxy will look for this
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001311 cookie both in the "Cookie:" headers, and as a URL parameter (depending on
1312 the mode used). If a known value is found, the client will be directed to the
1313 server associated with this value. Otherwise, the load balancing algorithm is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001314 applied. Cookies are automatically removed from memory when they have been
1315 unused for a duration longer than <holdtime>.
1316
1317 The definition of an application cookie is limited to one per backend.
1318
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001319 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
1320 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
1321 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
1322
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001323 Example :
1324 appsession JSESSIONID len 52 timeout 3h
1325
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001326 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table",
1327 "ignore-persist", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001328
1329
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001330backlog <conns>
1331 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
1332 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1333 yes | yes | yes | no
1334 Arguments :
1335 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
1336 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001337 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001338
1339 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
1340 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
1341 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
1342 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
1343 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
1344 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
1345 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
1346 backlog parameter.
1347
1348 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
1349 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
1350 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
1351
1352 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
1353
1354
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001355balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001356balance url_param <param> [check_post [<max_wait>]]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001357 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
1358 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1359 yes | no | yes | yes
1360 Arguments :
1361 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
1362 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
1363 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
1364 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
1365
1366 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1367 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
1368 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
1369 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001370 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
1371 design to 4128 active servers per backend. Note that in some
1372 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
1373 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
1374 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
1375 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
1376 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
1377 it, so that you don't worry.
1378
1379 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1380 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
1381 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
1382 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
1383 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
1384 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
1385 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
1386 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001387
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01001388 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
1389 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
1390 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
1391 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
1392 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
1393 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
1394 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
1395 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
1396
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001397 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
1398 connection. The servers are choosen from the lowest numeric
1399 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
1400 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001401 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001402 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
1403 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
1404 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
1405 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
1406 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001407 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
1408 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
1409 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
1410 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
1411 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
1412 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001413
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001414 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
1415 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
1416 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
1417 address will always reach the same server as long as no
1418 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
1419 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
1420 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
1421 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001422 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001423 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001424 static by default, which means that changing a server's
1425 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
1426 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001427
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001428 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
1429 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
1430 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
1431 the running servers. The result designates which server will
1432 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
1433 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
1434 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
1435 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
1436 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
1437 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1438 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1439 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001440
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001441 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001442 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
1443 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
1444 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
1445 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
1446 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
1447 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
1448 URIs start with a leading "/".
1449
1450 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
1451 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
1452 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
1453 evaluation stops when either is reached.
1454
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001455 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001456 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
1457
1458 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001459 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
1460 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
1461 ('?') in the URL. Optionally, specify a number of octets to
1462 wait for before attempting to search the message body. If the
1463 entity can not be searched, then round robin is used for each
1464 request. For instance, if your clients always send the LB
1465 parameter in the first 128 bytes, then specify that. The
1466 default is 48. The entity data will not be scanned until the
1467 required number of octets have arrived at the gateway, this
1468 is the minimum of: (default/max_wait, Content-Length or first
1469 chunk length). If Content-Length is missing or zero, it does
1470 not need to wait for more data than the client promised to
1471 send. When Content-Length is present and larger than
1472 <max_wait>, then waiting is limited to <max_wait> and it is
1473 assumed that this will be enough data to search for the
1474 presence of the parameter. In the unlikely event that
1475 Transfer-Encoding: chunked is used, only the first chunk is
1476 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
1477 be randomly balanced if at all.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001478
1479 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
1480 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
1481 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
1482 server will receive the request.
1483
1484 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
1485 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
1486 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
1487 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
1488 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001489 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
1490 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
1491 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001492
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001493 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
1494 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
1495 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
1496 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
1497 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001498
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001499 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001500 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
1501 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
1502 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
1503
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001504 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1505 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1506 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1507
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001508 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02001509 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001510 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
1511 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
1512 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
1513 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
1514 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
1515 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001516 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001517 used instead.
1518
1519 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
1520 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
1521 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
1522 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
1523
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001524 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1525 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1526 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1527
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001528 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09001529
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001530 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001531 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
1532 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001533
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001534 balance uri [len <len>] [depth <depth>]
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001535 balance url_param <param> [check_post [<max_wait>]]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001536
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01001537 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
1538 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
1539 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001540
1541 Examples :
1542 balance roundrobin
1543 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001544 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001545 balance hdr(User-Agent)
1546 balance hdr(host)
1547 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001548
1549 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
1550 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
1551
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001552 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001553 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
1554 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
1555 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
1556 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
1557
1558 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
1559 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
1560 defaults to 16 kB.
1561
1562 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
1563 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
1564
1565 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
1566 Round Robin.
1567
1568 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC2616 3.6.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
1569 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
1570 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
1571 actually appeared in the first chunk).
1572
1573 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
1574
1575 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001576 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001577 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
1578 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
1579 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001580
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001581 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "appsession", "transparent", "hash-type" and
1582 "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001583
1584
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001585bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
1586bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001587 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
1588 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1589 no | yes | yes | no
1590 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001591 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
1592 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
1593 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
1594 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01001595 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001596
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001597 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
1598 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001599 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
1600 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
1601 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001602 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
1603 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
1604 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
1605 the range.
1606
1607 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
1608 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
1609 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
1610 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
1611 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
1612 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
1613 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001614 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001615 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001616
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001617 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
1618 alternative to the TCP listening port. Haproxy will then
1619 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
1620 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
1621 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
1622 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
1623 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
1624 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
1625
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001626 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
1627 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
1628 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
1629 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001630
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001631 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
1632 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
1633 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
1634 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
1635 in a frontend.
1636
1637 Example :
1638 listen http_proxy
1639 bind :80,:443
1640 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001641 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001642
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001643 listen http_https_proxy
1644 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02001645 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001646
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001647 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001648 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001649
1650
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01001651bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-32>[-<number 1-32>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001652 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
1653 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1654 yes | yes | yes | yes
1655 Arguments :
1656 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
1657 may be used to override a default value.
1658
1659 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...31. This
1660 option may be combined with other numbers.
1661
1662 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...32. This
1663 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
1664 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
1665 missing from all processes.
1666
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01001667 number The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
1668 whose values must all be between 1 and 32. You must be
1669 careful not to reference a process number greater than the
1670 configured global.nbproc, otherwise some instances might be
1671 missing from all processes.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001672
1673 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
1674 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
1675 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
1676 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
1677 and 'even' instances.
1678
1679 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 processes using
1680 this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups. Please
1681 note that 'all' really means all processes and is not limited to the first
1682 32.
1683
1684 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
1685 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
1686
1687 Example :
1688 listen app_ip1
1689 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001690 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001691
1692 listen app_ip2
1693 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001694 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001695
1696 listen management
1697 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001698 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001699
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01001700 listen management
1701 bind 10.0.0.4:80
1702 bind-process 1-4
1703
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001704 See also : "nbproc" in global section.
1705
1706
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001707block { if | unless } <condition>
1708 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
1709 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1710 no | yes | yes | yes
1711
1712 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
1713 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001714 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02001715 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001716 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
1717 "block" statements per instance.
1718
1719 Example:
1720 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1721 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1722 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1723 block if invalid_src || local_dst
1724
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001725 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001726
1727
1728capture cookie <name> len <length>
1729 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
1730 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1731 no | yes | yes | no
1732 Arguments :
1733 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
1734 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
1735 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
1736 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
1737 and value (eg: ASPSESSIONXXXXX).
1738
1739 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
1740 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
1741 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
1742 right if it exceeds <length>.
1743
1744 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
1745 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
1746 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
1747 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
1748
1749 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
1750 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
1751 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
1752
1753 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
1754 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
1755 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001756 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
1757 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
1758 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001759
1760 Example:
1761 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
1762
1763 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001764 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001765
1766
1767capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01001768 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001769 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1770 no | yes | yes | no
1771 Arguments :
1772 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001773 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001774 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
1775 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
1776 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
1777
1778 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
1779 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
1780 it exceeds <length>.
1781
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01001782 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001783 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
1784 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001785 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
1786 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
1787 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
1788 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001789 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001790 environments to find where the request came from.
1791
1792 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
1793 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
1794 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
1795 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001796
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01001797 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
1798 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
1799 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
1800 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
1801 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001802
1803 Example:
1804 capture request header Host len 15
1805 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
1806 capture request header Referrer len 15
1807
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001808 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001809 about logging.
1810
1811
1812capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01001813 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001814 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1815 no | yes | yes | no
1816 Arguments :
1817 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001818 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001819 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
1820 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
1821 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
1822
1823 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
1824 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
1825 it exceeds <length>.
1826
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01001827 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001828 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
1829 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
1830 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001831 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
1832 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
1833 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
1834 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001835
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01001836 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
1837 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
1838 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
1839 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
1840 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001841
1842 Example:
1843 capture response header Content-length len 9
1844 capture response header Location len 15
1845
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001846 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001847 about logging.
1848
1849
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001850clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001851 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
1852 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1853 yes | yes | yes | no
1854 Arguments :
1855 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
1856 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
1857 as explained at the top of this document.
1858
1859 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
1860 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
1861 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
1862 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
1863 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
1864 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
1865 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
1866 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001867 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001868 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
1869 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
1870
1871 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
1872 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
1873 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
1874 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
1875 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
1876 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
1877
1878 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
1879 Please use "timeout client" instead.
1880
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01001881 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
1882 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001883
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01001884compression algo <algorithm> ...
1885compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02001886compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001887 Enable HTTP compression.
1888 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1889 yes | yes | yes | yes
1890 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01001891 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
1892 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
1893 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
1894
1895 The currently supported algorithms are :
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04001896 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01001897 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
1898 data.
1899
1900 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
1901 support for zlib was built in.
1902
1903 deflate same as gzip, but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
1904 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many browsers
1905 and no support at all from recent ones. It is strongly
1906 recommended not to use it for anything else than experimentation.
1907 This setting is only available when support for zlib was built
1908 in.
1909
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04001910 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01001911 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04001912 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
1913 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
1914 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
1915 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
1916 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02001917
1918 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
1919 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
1920 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
1921 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
1922 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04001923 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
1924 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
1925 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
1926 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
1927 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
1928 then be used for such scenarios.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001929
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01001930 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01001931 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
1932 "Accept-Encoding" header
1933 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
William Lallemandd3002612012-11-26 14:34:47 +01001934 * HTTP status code is not 200
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01001935 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
1936 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
1937 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
1938 "multipart"
1939 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
1940 header
1941 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
1942 and later
1943 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
1944 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01001945
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01001946 Note: The compression does not rewrite Etag headers, and does not emit the
1947 Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01001948
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001949 Examples :
1950 compression algo gzip
1951 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001952
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001953contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001954 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
1955 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1956 yes | no | yes | yes
1957 Arguments :
1958 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
1959 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
1960 as explained at the top of this document.
1961
1962 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001963 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001964 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001965 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
1966 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
1967 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
1968 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
1969
1970 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
1971 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
1972 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
1973 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
1974 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
1975 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
1976
1977 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
1978 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
1979 instead.
1980
1981 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
1982 "timeout server", "contimeout".
1983
1984
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02001985cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02001986 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
1987 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001988 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
1989 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1990 yes | no | yes | yes
1991 Arguments :
1992 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
1993 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
1994 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
1995 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
1996 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
1997 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
1998 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (eg:
1999 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
2000 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
2001
2002 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
2003 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
2004 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
2005 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
2006 headers is left to the application. The application can then
2007 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
2008 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode only
2009 works in HTTP close mode. Unless the application behaviour is
2010 very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to start with this
2011 mode for new deployments. This keyword is incompatible with
2012 "insert" and "prefix".
2013
2014 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002015 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002016
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002017 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002018 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
2019 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
2020 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
2021 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
2022 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
2023 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
2024 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
2025 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
2026 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
2027 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002028
2029 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
2030 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
2031 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
2032 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
2033 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
2034 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
2035 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
2036 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
2037 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
2038 this mode requires the HTTP close mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002039 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
2040 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
2041 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002042
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002043 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
2044 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
2045 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002046 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
2047 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
2048 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
2049 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002050 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
2051 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
2052 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002053
2054 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
2055 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
2056 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
2057 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
2058 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
2059 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
2060 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
2061 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
2062 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
2063
2064 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
2065 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
2066 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
2067 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
2068 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
2069 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
2070 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
2071 persistence cookie in the cache.
2072 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
2073
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002074 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
2075 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
2076 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
2077 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
2078 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
2079 emit a cookie with an invalid value (eg: empty) or with a date in
2080 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
2081 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
2082 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
2083 they logout.
2084
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002085 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
2086 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
2087 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
2088 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
2089
2090 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
2091 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
2092 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
2093 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
2094 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
2095 this attribute.
2096
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002097 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002098 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01002099 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
2100 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
2101 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
2102 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
2103 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
2104 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002105
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002106 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
2107 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
2108 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
2109 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
2110 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
2111 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
2112 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
2113 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2114 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). When
2115 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
2116 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
2117 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
2118 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
2119 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
2120 the site.
2121
2122 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
2123 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
2124 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
2125 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
2126 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
2127 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
2128 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
2129 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
2130 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
2131 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
2132 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
2133 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
2134 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2135 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). This
2136 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
2137 redispatch after some absolute delay.
2138
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002139 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
2140 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
2141 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
2142 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002143
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002144 Examples :
2145 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
2146 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
2147 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002148 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002149
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002150 See also : "appsession", "balance source", "capture cookie", "server"
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002151 and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002152
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002153
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002154default-server [param*]
2155 Change default options for a server in a backend
2156 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2157 yes | no | yes | yes
2158 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002159 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2160 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2161 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2162 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002163
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002164 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002165 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
2166
2167 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002168
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002169
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002170default_backend <backend>
2171 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
2172 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2173 yes | yes | yes | no
2174 Arguments :
2175 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
2176
2177 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
2178 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
2179 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
2180 will catch all undetermined requests.
2181
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002182 Example :
2183
2184 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
2185 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
2186 default_backend dynamic
2187
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002188 See also : "use_backend", "reqsetbe", "reqisetbe"
2189
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002190
2191disabled
2192 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2193 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2194 yes | yes | yes | yes
2195 Arguments : none
2196
2197 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
2198 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
2199 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
2200 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
2201 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
2202 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
2203 keyword in a "defaults" section.
2204
2205 See also : "enabled"
2206
2207
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002208dispatch <address>:<port>
2209 Set a default server address
2210 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2211 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002212 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002213
2214 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
2215 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
2216 during start-up.
2217
2218 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
2219 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
2220 possible with normal servers.
2221
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02002222 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002223 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
2224 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
2225 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
2226 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
2227
2228 See also : "server"
2229
2230
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002231enabled
2232 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2233 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2234 yes | yes | yes | yes
2235 Arguments : none
2236
2237 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
2238 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
2239
2240 See also : "disabled"
2241
2242
2243errorfile <code> <file>
2244 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2245 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2246 yes | yes | yes | yes
2247 Arguments :
2248 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002249 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002250
2251 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002252 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002253 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002254 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2255 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002256
2257 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2258 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2259 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2260
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002261 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2262
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002263 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
2264 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
2265 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
2266 files returning the same contents as default errors.
2267
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002268 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
2269 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
2270 not to put any reference to local contents (eg: images) in order to avoid
2271 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
2272 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
2273 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
2274
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002275 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
2276 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
2277 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01002278 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002279 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
2280
2281 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
2282
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002283 Example :
2284 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
2285 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
2286 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
2287
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002288
2289errorloc <code> <url>
2290errorloc302 <code> <url>
2291 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2292 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2293 yes | yes | yes | yes
2294 Arguments :
2295 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002296 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002297
2298 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2299 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2300 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2301 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2302 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2303
2304 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2305 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2306 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2307
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002308 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2309
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002310 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
2311 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
2312 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
2313 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
2314 workaround this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
2315 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
2316 request.
2317
2318 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
2319
2320
2321errorloc303 <code> <url>
2322 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2323 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2324 yes | yes | yes | yes
2325 Arguments :
2326 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
2327 generating codes 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
2328
2329 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2330 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2331 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2332 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2333 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2334
2335 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2336 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2337 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2338
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002339 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2340
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002341 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
2342 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
2343 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
2344 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002345 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002346
2347 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
2348
2349
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002350force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
2351 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
2352 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2353 no | yes | yes | yes
2354
2355 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
2356 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
2357 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
2358 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
2359 marked down for maintenance operations.
2360
2361 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
2362 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
2363 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
2364 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
2365 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
2366 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
2367 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
2368 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
2369 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
2370
2371 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
2372 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
2373 is used.
2374
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002375 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002376 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002377
2378
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002379fullconn <conns>
2380 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
2381 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2382 yes | no | yes | yes
2383 Arguments :
2384 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
2385 servers use the maximal number of connections.
2386
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002387 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002388 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002389 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002390 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
2391 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
2392 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
2393 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
2394 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002395 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002396
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02002397 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
2398 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
2399 backend. That way it's safe to leave it unset.
2400
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002401 Example :
2402 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
2403 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
2404 # connections.
2405 backend dynamic
2406 fullconn 10000
2407 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2408 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2409
2410 See also : "maxconn", "server"
2411
2412
2413grace <time>
2414 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
2415 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01002416 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002417 Arguments :
2418 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
2419 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
2420 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
2421
2422 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
2423 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002424 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002425 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
2426
2427 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
2428 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
2429 simplify it.
2430
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002431
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002432hash-type <method>
2433 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
2434 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2435 yes | no | yes | yes
2436 Arguments :
2437 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
2438 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but will
2439 be static in that weight changes while a server is up will be
2440 ignored. This means that there will be no slow start. Also,
2441 since a server is selected by its position in the array, most
2442 mappings are changed when the server count changes. This means
2443 that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is added
2444 to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to different
2445 servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for instance.
2446
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01002447 avalanche this mechanism uses the default map-based hashing described
2448 above but applies a full avalanche hash before performing the
2449 mapping. The result is a slightly less smooth hash for most
2450 situations, but the hash becomes better than pure map-based
2451 hashes when the number of servers is a multiple of the size of
2452 the input set. When using URI hash with a number of servers
2453 multiple of 64, it's desirable to change the hash type to
2454 this value.
2455
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002456 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
2457 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
2458 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
2459 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
2460 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
2461 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a server
2462 is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings are
2463 redistributed, making it an ideal algorithm for caches.
2464 However, due to its principle, the algorithm will never be very
2465 smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a server's
2466 weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution. In order
2467 to get the same distribution on multiple load balancers, it is
2468 important that all servers have the same IDs.
2469
2470 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages.
2471
2472 See also : "balance", "server"
2473
2474
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002475http-check disable-on-404
2476 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
2477 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002478 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002479 Arguments : none
2480
2481 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
2482 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
2483 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
2484 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
2485 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
2486 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
2487 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
2488 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002489 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
2490 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
2491 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
2492
2493 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
2494
2495
2496http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002497 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002498 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02002499 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002500 Arguments :
2501 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
2502 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002503 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002504 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
2505 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
2506 details on the supported keywords.
2507
2508 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
2509 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
2510 with the usual backslash ('\').
2511
2512 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
2513 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
2514 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
2515 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
2516 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
2517
2518 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002519 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002520 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
2521 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2522 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2523
2524 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002525 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002526 response's status code matches the expression. If the
2527 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2528 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2529 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
2530
2531 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002532 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002533 response's body contains this exact string. If the
2534 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2535 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
2536 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
2537 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
2538 specific error appears on the check page (eg: a stack
2539 trace).
2540
2541 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002542 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002543 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
2544 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
2545 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
2546 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
2547 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
2548 error appears on the check page (eg: a stack trace).
2549
2550 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
2551 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
2552 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
2553 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
2554 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
2555 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
2556 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
2557 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
2558
2559 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
2560 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
2561
2562 Examples :
2563 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002564 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002565
2566 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002567 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002568
2569 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002570 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002571
2572 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002573 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*</html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002574
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002575 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002576
2577
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01002578http-check send-state
2579 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
2580 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2581 yes | no | yes | yes
2582 Arguments : none
2583
2584 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
2585 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
2586 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
2587 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
2588 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
2589
2590 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
2591 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
2592 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
2593 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
2594 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
2595 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
2596 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
2597 checked in multiple backends.
2598
2599 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
2600 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
2601
2602 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
2603 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
2604 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
2605 one fails.
2606
2607 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
2608 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
2609 connections on all servers of the same backend.
2610
2611 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
2612 server's queue.
2613
2614 Example of a header received by the application server :
2615 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
2616 scur=13/22; qcur=0
2617
2618 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
2619
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01002620http-request { allow | deny | tarpit | auth [realm <realm>] | redirect <rule> |
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002621 add-header <name> <fmt> | set-header <name> <fmt> }
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002622 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002623 Access control for Layer 7 requests
2624
2625 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2626 no | yes | yes | yes
2627
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002628 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
2629 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
2630 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
2631 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
2632 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002633
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002634 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
2635 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request
2636 pass the check. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
2637
2638 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
2639 the request and emits an HTTP 403 error. No further "http-request" rules
2640 are evaluated.
2641
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01002642 - "tarpit" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks
2643 the request without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit"
2644 or "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the
2645 client is still connected, an HTTP error 500 is returned so that the
2646 client does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags
2647 "PT". The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack
2648 when they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
2649 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the
2650 load on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
2651 developped robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the
2652 front firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections.
2653
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002654 - "auth" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds
2655 with an HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid
2656 user name and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An
2657 optional "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm
2658 that is returned with the response (typically the application's name).
2659
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01002660 - "redirect" : this performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
2661 This is exactly the same as the "redirect" statement except that it
2662 inserts a redirect rule which can be processed in the middle of other
2663 "http-request" rules. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax.
2664
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002665 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
2666 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
2667 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly
2668 useful to pass connection-specific information to the server (eg: the
2669 client's SSL certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This
2670 rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note
2671 that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
2672 the resulting header from a previous rule.
2673
2674 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
2675 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
2676 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
2677 external users.
2678
2679 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
2680
2681 It is important to know that http-request rules are processed very early in
2682 the HTTP processing, just after "block" rules and before "reqdel" or "reqrep"
2683 rules. That way, headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by
2684 almost all further ACL rules.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002685
2686 Example:
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002687 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
2688 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
2689 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002690
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002691 http-request allow if nagios
2692 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
2693 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
2694 http-request deny
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002695
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002696 Example:
2697 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002698 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002699
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002700 Example:
2701 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
2702 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
2703 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id]
2704 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
2705 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
2706 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
2707 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
2708 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
2709 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
2710
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02002711 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
2712 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01002713
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05002714http-send-name-header [<header>]
2715 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
2716
2717 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2718 yes | no | yes | yes
2719
2720 Arguments :
2721
2722 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
2723
2724 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the name of the target
2725 server to be added to the headers of an HTTP request. The name
2726 is added with the header string proved.
2727
2728 See also : "server"
2729
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01002730id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02002731 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
2732 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2733 no | yes | yes | yes
2734 Arguments : none
2735
2736 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
2737 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
2738 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01002739
2740
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002741ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
2742 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
2743 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2744 no | yes | yes | yes
2745
2746 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
2747 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
2748 and running).
2749
2750 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
2751 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
2752 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
2753 oftenly don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
2754 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
2755
2756 Combined with "appsession", it can also help reduce HAProxy memory usage, as
2757 the appsession table won't grow if persistence is ignored.
2758
2759 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
2760 "unless" condition is met.
2761
2762 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
2763
2764
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002765log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02002766log <address> <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002767no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002768 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
2769 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2770 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002771
2772 Prefix :
2773 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
2774 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
2775 prefix does not allow arguments.
2776
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002777 Arguments :
2778 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
2779 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
2780 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
2781 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
2782 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
2783 parameter.
2784
2785 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
2786 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
2787
2788 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
2789 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
2790 standard syslog port).
2791
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01002792 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
2793 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
2794 standard syslog port).
2795
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002796 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
2797 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
2798 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
2799 appropriately writeable).
2800
2801 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
2802
2803 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
2804 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
2805 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
2806
2807 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
2808 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
2809 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02002810 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
2811 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
2812 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
2813 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
2814 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002815
2816 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
2817
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002818 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
2819 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
2820 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002821
2822 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
2823 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
2824 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
2825 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
2826
2827 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
2828 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002829
2830 Example :
2831 log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02002832 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
2833 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002834
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01002835log-format <string>
2836 Allows you to custom a log line.
2837
2838 See also : Custom Log Format (8.2.4)
2839
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002840
2841maxconn <conns>
2842 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
2843 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2844 yes | yes | yes | no
2845 Arguments :
2846 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
2847 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
2848 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
2849 closes.
2850
2851 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
2852 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
2853 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
2854 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
2855 of 8kB each, as well as some other data resulting in about 17 kB of RAM being
2856 consumed per established connection. That means that a medium system equipped
2857 with 1GB of RAM can withstand around 40000-50000 concurrent connections if
2858 properly tuned.
2859
2860 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
2861 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
2862 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
2863
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02002864 By default, this value is set to 2000.
2865
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002866 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
2867
2868
2869mode { tcp|http|health }
2870 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
2871 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2872 yes | yes | yes | yes
2873 Arguments :
2874 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
2875 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
2876 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
2877 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
2878
2879 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
2880 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
2881 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
2882 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
2883 brings HAProxy most of its value.
2884
2885 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02002886 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
2887 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
2888 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
2889 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
2890 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
2891 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
2892 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002893
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002894 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
2895 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
2896 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002897
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002898 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002899 defaults http_instances
2900 mode http
2901
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002902 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002903
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002904
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002905monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002906 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002907 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2908 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002909 Arguments :
2910 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
2911 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002912 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002913 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
2914 backend and its backup.
2915
2916 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
2917 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
2918 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
2919 servers in a list of backends.
2920
2921 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
2922 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
2923 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
2924 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
2925 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
2926 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
2927 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002928 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
2929 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002930
2931 Example:
2932 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002933 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002934 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
2935 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
2936 monitor-uri /site_alive
2937 monitor fail if site_dead
2938
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002939 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002940
2941
2942monitor-net <source>
2943 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
2944 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2945 yes | yes | yes | no
2946 Arguments :
2947 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
2948 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
2949 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
2950 followed by a mask.
2951
2952 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
2953 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002954 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002955 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
2956
2957 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
2958 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
2959 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
2960 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02002961 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
2962 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
2963 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002964
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02002965 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
2966 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
2967 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
2968 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
2969 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
2970 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002971
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01002972 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
2973 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002974
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002975 Example :
2976 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
2977 frontend www
2978 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
2979
2980 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
2981
2982
2983monitor-uri <uri>
2984 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
2985 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2986 yes | yes | yes | no
2987 Arguments :
2988 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
2989 health status instead of forwarding the request.
2990
2991 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
2992 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
2993 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
2994 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
2995 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
2996 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
2997 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
2998 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
2999
3000 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
3001 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
3002 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
3003 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
3004 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
3005 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
3006
3007 Example :
3008 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
3009 frontend www
3010 mode http
3011 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
3012
3013 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
3014
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003015
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003016option abortonclose
3017no option abortonclose
3018 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
3019 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3020 yes | no | yes | yes
3021 Arguments : none
3022
3023 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
3024 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
3025 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
3026 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003027 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003028 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
3029 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
3030 encountered while delivering the response.
3031
3032 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
3033 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
3034 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
3035 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
3036 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
3037 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003038 support this behaviour (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003039 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003040 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003041 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
3042 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
3043 still not served and not pollute the servers.
3044
3045 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behaviour using the option
3046 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behaviour is HTTP
3047 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
3048 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
3049 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
3050 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
3051 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
3052 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003053 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003054
3055 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3056 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3057
3058 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
3059
3060
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003061option accept-invalid-http-request
3062no option accept-invalid-http-request
3063 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
3064 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3065 yes | yes | yes | no
3066 Arguments : none
3067
3068 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
3069 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
3070 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
3071 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
3072 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
3073 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
3074 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
3075 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01003076 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
3077 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
3078 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
3079 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
3080 not allowed at all. Haproxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
3081 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003082
3083 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
3084 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
3085 been confirmed.
3086
3087 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
3088 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01003089 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
3090 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003091 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
3092
3093 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3094 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3095
3096 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
3097 stats socket.
3098
3099
3100option accept-invalid-http-response
3101no option accept-invalid-http-response
3102 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
3103 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3104 yes | no | yes | yes
3105 Arguments : none
3106
3107 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
3108 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
3109 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
3110 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
3111 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
3112 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
3113 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
3114 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
3115 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option.
3116
3117 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
3118 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
3119 been confirmed.
3120
3121 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
3122 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
3123 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
3124 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
3125
3126 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3127 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3128
3129 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
3130 stats socket.
3131
3132
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003133option allbackups
3134no option allbackups
3135 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
3136 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3137 yes | no | yes | yes
3138 Arguments : none
3139
3140 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
3141 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
3142 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
3143 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
3144 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
3145 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
3146 order between the backup servers anymore.
3147
3148 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
3149 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
3150
3151 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3152 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3153
3154
3155option checkcache
3156no option checkcache
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003157 Analyze all server responses and block requests with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003158 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3159 yes | no | yes | yes
3160 Arguments : none
3161
3162 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
3163 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003164 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003165 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
3166 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02003167 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003168
3169 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003170 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003171 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003172 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
3173 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003174 to the client are :
3175 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003176 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 206, 300, 301, 410,
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003177 provided that the server has not set a "Cache-control: public" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003178 - all those that come from a POST request, provided that the server has not
3179 set a 'Cache-Control: public' header ;
3180 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
3181 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
3182 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
3183 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
3184 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
3185 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
3186 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
3187 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
3188 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
3189
3190 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003191 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003192 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003193 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003194 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
3195
3196 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
3197 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003198 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003199 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviours.
3200
3201 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3202 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3203
3204
3205option clitcpka
3206no option clitcpka
3207 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
3208 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3209 yes | yes | yes | no
3210 Arguments : none
3211
3212 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
3213 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
3214 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
3215 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
3216
3217 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
3218 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
3219 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
3220 operating system and its tuning parameters.
3221
3222 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
3223 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
3224 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
3225 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
3226 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
3227
3228 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
3229
3230 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
3231 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
3232 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
3233
3234 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3235 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3236
3237 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
3238
3239
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003240option contstats
3241 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
3242 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3243 yes | yes | yes | no
3244 Arguments : none
3245
3246 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
3247 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
3248 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
3249 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
3250 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented continuously,
3251 during a whole session. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so
3252 it is not enabled by default, as it has small performance impact (~0.5%).
3253
3254
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003255option dontlog-normal
3256no option dontlog-normal
3257 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
3258 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3259 yes | yes | yes | no
3260 Arguments : none
3261
3262 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
3263 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
3264 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
3265 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
3266 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
3267 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
3268 logged.
3269
3270 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
3271 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
3272 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
3273
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003274 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003275 logging.
3276
3277
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003278option dontlognull
3279no option dontlognull
3280 Enable or disable logging of null connections
3281 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3282 yes | yes | yes | no
3283 Arguments : none
3284
3285 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
3286 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
3287 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
3288 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
3289 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
3290 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
3291 which typically corresponds to those probes.
3292
3293 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
3294 environments (eg: internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
3295 would not be logged.
3296
3297 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3298 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3299
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003300 See also : "log", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003301
3302
3303option forceclose
3304no option forceclose
3305 Enable or disable active connection closing after response is transferred.
3306 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaua31e5df2009-12-30 01:10:35 +01003307 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003308 Arguments : none
3309
3310 Some HTTP servers do not necessarily close the connections when they receive
3311 the "Connection: close" set by "option httpclose", and if the client does not
3312 close either, then the connection remains open till the timeout expires. This
3313 causes high number of simultaneous connections on the servers and shows high
3314 global session times in the logs.
3315
3316 When this happens, it is possible to use "option forceclose". It will
Willy Tarreau82eeaf22009-12-29 12:09:05 +01003317 actively close the outgoing server channel as soon as the server has finished
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003318 to respond. This option implicitly enables the "httpclose" option. Note that
3319 this option also enables the parsing of the full request and response, which
3320 means we can close the connection to the server very quickly, releasing some
3321 resources earlier than with httpclose.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003322
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003323 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
3324 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
3325 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
3326
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003327 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3328 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3329
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003330 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003331
3332
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003333option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003334 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
3335 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3336 yes | yes | yes | yes
3337 Arguments :
3338 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
3339 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003340 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003341 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003342
3343 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
3344 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
3345 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
3346 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
3347 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
3348 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
3349 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003350 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
3351 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
3352 possible that the client has already brought one.
3353
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003354 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003355 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003356 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (eg: stunnel),
3357 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003358 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (eg: Zeus Web Servers
3359 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003360
3361 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
3362 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
3363 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
3364 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
3365 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
3366 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
3367 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
3368
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003369 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
3370 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
3371 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
3372 are under the control of the end-user.
3373
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003374 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003375 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
3376 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003377 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
3378 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
3379 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003380
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003381 It is important to note that by default, HAProxy works in tunnel mode and
3382 only inspects the first request of a connection, meaning that only the first
3383 request will have the header appended, which is certainly not what you want.
3384 In order to fix this, ensure that any of the "httpclose", "forceclose" or
3385 "http-server-close" options is set when using this option.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003386
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003387 Examples :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003388 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
3389 frontend www
3390 mode http
3391 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
3392
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003393 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
3394 backend www
3395 mode http
3396 option forwardfor header X-Client
3397
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003398 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
3399 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003400
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003401
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02003402option http-no-delay
3403no option http-no-delay
3404 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
3405 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3406 yes | yes | yes | yes
3407 Arguments : none
3408
3409 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
3410 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
3411 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
3412 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
3413 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
3414 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
3415 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
3416 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
3417 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
3418 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
3419 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
3420 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
3421 affected.
3422
3423 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
3424 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
3425 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
3426 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
3427 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
3428 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
3429 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
3430 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
3431 latency environments.
3432
3433
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003434option http-pretend-keepalive
3435no option http-pretend-keepalive
3436 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
3437 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3438 yes | yes | yes | yes
3439 Arguments : none
3440
3441 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose", haproxy
3442 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
3443 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
3444 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
3445 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
3446 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
3447 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
3448 consider the response complete.
3449
3450 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
3451 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
3452 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
3453 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
3454 "forceclose" option. That way the client gets a normal response and the
3455 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
3456
3457 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
3458 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
3459 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
3460 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
3461 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
3462 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
3463 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
3464
3465 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3466 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003467 This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will cause
Willy Tarreau22a95342010-09-29 14:31:41 +02003468 keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to the
3469 client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003470
3471 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3472 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3473
3474 See also : "option forceclose" and "option http-server-close"
3475
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003476
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003477option http-server-close
3478no option http-server-close
3479 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
3480 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3481 yes | yes | yes | yes
3482 Arguments : none
3483
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003484 By default, when a client communicates with a server, HAProxy will only
3485 analyze, log, and process the first request of each connection. Setting
3486 "option http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server
3487 side while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on
3488 the client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
3489 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
3490 resources, similarly to "option forceclose". It also permits non-keepalive
3491 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
3492 conform to the requirements of RFC2616. Please note that some servers do not
3493 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
3494 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
3495 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003496
3497 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
3498 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
3499 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
3500 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01003501 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
3502 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003503
3504 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3505 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003506 It is worth noting that "option forceclose" has precedence over "option
3507 http-server-close" and that combining "http-server-close" with "httpclose"
3508 basically achieve the same result as "forceclose".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003509
3510 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3511 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3512
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003513 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
3514 "option httpclose" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003515
3516
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003517option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003518no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003519 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
3520 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3521 yes | yes | yes | no
3522 Arguments : none
3523
3524 While RFC2616 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
3525 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
3526 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
3527 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
3528 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
3529 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
3530 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
3531
3532 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
3533 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
3534 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. The
3535 choice of header only affects requests passing through proxies making use of
3536 one of the "httpclose", "forceclose" and "http-server-close" options. Note
3537 that this option can only be specified in a frontend and will affect the
3538 request along its whole life.
3539
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01003540 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
3541 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
3542 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
3543 front of an existing proxy.
3544
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003545 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
3546
3547 See also : "option httpclose", "option forceclose" and "option
3548 http-server-close".
3549
3550
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01003551option httpchk
3552option httpchk <uri>
3553option httpchk <method> <uri>
3554option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
3555 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
3556 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3557 yes | no | yes | yes
3558 Arguments :
3559 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
3560 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
3561 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
3562 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
3563 ones.
3564
3565 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
3566 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
3567 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
3568
3569 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
3570 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
3571 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
3572 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
3573 after "\r\n" following the version string.
3574
3575 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
3576 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
3577 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
3578 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
3579 the lack of any response.
3580
3581 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
3582
3583 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
3584 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
3585 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
3586
3587 Examples :
3588 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
3589 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
3590 backend https_relay
3591 mode tcp
3592 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
3593 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
3594
3595 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01003596 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
3597 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01003598
3599
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003600option httpclose
3601no option httpclose
3602 Enable or disable passive HTTP connection closing
3603 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3604 yes | yes | yes | yes
3605 Arguments : none
3606
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003607 By default, when a client communicates with a server, HAProxy will only
3608 analyze, log, and process the first request of each connection. If "option
3609 httpclose" is set, it will check if a "Connection: close" header is already
3610 set in each direction, and will add one if missing. Each end should react to
3611 this by actively closing the TCP connection after each transfer, thus
3612 resulting in a switch to the HTTP close mode. Any "Connection" header
3613 different from "close" will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003614
3615 It seldom happens that some servers incorrectly ignore this header and do not
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003616 close the connection even though they reply "Connection: close". For this
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003617 reason, they are not compatible with older HTTP 1.0 browsers. If this happens
3618 it is possible to use the "option forceclose" which actively closes the
3619 request connection once the server responds. Option "forceclose" also
3620 releases the server connection earlier because it does not have to wait for
3621 the client to acknowledge it.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003622
3623 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3624 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
3625 If "option forceclose" is specified too, it has precedence over "httpclose".
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003626 If "option http-server-close" is enabled at the same time as "httpclose", it
3627 basically achieves the same result as "option forceclose".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003628
3629 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3630 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3631
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003632 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close" and
3633 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003634
3635
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02003636option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003637 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
3638 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3639 yes | yes | yes | yes
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02003640 Arguments :
3641 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
3642 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
3643 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
3644 log analyser which only support the CLF format and which is not
3645 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003646
3647 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
3648 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
3649 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
3650 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
3651 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
3652 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
3653 ports.
3654
3655 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
3656
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02003657 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3658 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it. Specifying
3659 only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode if it was set
3660 by default.
3661
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003662 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003663
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003664
3665option http_proxy
3666no option http_proxy
3667 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
3668 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3669 yes | yes | yes | yes
3670 Arguments : none
3671
3672 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
3673 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
3674 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
3675 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
3676 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
3677
3678 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
3679 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
3680 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. Last,
3681 if the clients are susceptible of sending keep-alive requests, it will be
Cyril Bonté2409e682010-12-14 22:47:51 +01003682 needed to add "option httpclose" to ensure that all requests will correctly
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003683 be analyzed.
3684
3685 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3686 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3687
3688 Example :
3689 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
3690 backend direct_forward
3691 option httpclose
3692 option http_proxy
3693
3694 See also : "option httpclose"
3695
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02003696
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003697option independent-streams
3698no option independent-streams
3699 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02003700 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3701 yes | yes | yes | yes
3702 Arguments : none
3703
3704 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
3705 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
3706 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
3707 receive data or not.
3708
3709 While this default behaviour is desirable for almost all applications, there
3710 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
3711 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
3712 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
3713 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
3714 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
3715 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
3716 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
3717 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
3718 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
3719 socket buffers.
3720
3721 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
3722 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
3723 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
3724 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
3725 slow lines, so use it with caution.
3726
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003727 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independant-streams"
3728 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
3729 deprecated.
3730
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02003731 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02003732
3733
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02003734option ldap-check
3735 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
3736 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3737 yes | no | yes | yes
3738 Arguments : none
3739
3740 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
3741 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
3742 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
3743 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
3744
3745 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
3746 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
3747
3748 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
3749 configure it.
3750
3751 Example :
3752 option ldap-check
3753
3754 See also : "option httpchk"
3755
3756
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02003757option log-health-checks
3758no option log-health-checks
3759 Enable or disable logging of health checks
3760 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3761 yes | no | yes | yes
3762 Arguments : none
3763
3764 Enable health checks logging so it possible to check for example what
3765 was happening before a server crash. Failed health check are logged if
3766 server is UP and succeeded health checks if server is DOWN, so the amount
3767 of additional information is limited.
3768
3769 If health check logging is enabled no health check status is printed
3770 when servers is set up UP/DOWN/ENABLED/DISABLED.
3771
3772 See also: "log" and section 8 about logging.
3773
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003774
3775option log-separate-errors
3776no option log-separate-errors
3777 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
3778 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3779 yes | yes | yes | no
3780 Arguments : none
3781
3782 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
3783 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
3784 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
3785 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
3786 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
3787 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
3788 provides very important information.
3789
3790 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
3791 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
3792 error logs.
3793
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003794 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003795 logging.
3796
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003797
3798option logasap
3799no option logasap
3800 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
3801 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3802 yes | yes | yes | no
3803 Arguments : none
3804
3805 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
3806 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
3807 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
3808 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
3809 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
3810 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
3811 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003812 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003813 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
3814 bytes are expected to be transferred.
3815
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003816 Examples :
3817 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
3818 mode http
3819 option httplog
3820 option logasap
3821 log 192.168.2.200 local3
3822
3823 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
3824 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
3825 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
3826 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
3827
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003828 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003829 logging.
3830
3831
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02003832option mysql-check [ user <username> ]
3833 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003834 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3835 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02003836 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003837 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
3838 server.
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02003839
3840 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
3841 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
3842 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialisation packet and/or
3843 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
3844 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
3845 in the MySQL table, like this :
3846
3847 USE mysql;
3848 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
3849 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
3850
3851 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
3852 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialisation packet or
3853 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
3854 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
3855 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
3856 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
3857 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
3858 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
3859 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
3860
3861 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
3862 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003863
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02003864 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003865
3866 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
3867 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
3868 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
3869 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
3870 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL server
3871 to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
3872
3873 See also: "option httpchk"
3874
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01003875option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
3876 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
3877 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3878 yes | no | yes | yes
3879 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003880 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
3881 PostgreSQL server.
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01003882
3883 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
3884 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
3885 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
3886 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
3887
3888 See also: "option httpchk"
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003889
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003890option nolinger
3891no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003892 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003893 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3894 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01003895 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003896
3897 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (eg: they are
3898 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
3899 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
3900 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
3901 connections.
3902
3903 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
3904 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
3905 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
3906 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
3907 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
3908 this too.
3909
3910 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
3911 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
3912 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
3913
3914 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
3915 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
3916 for servers.
3917
3918 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3919 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3920
3921
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003922option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
3923 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
3924 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3925 yes | yes | yes | yes
3926 Arguments :
3927 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
3928 matching <network>
3929 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
3930 header name.
3931
3932 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
3933 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
3934 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
3935 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
3936 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
3937 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
3938 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
3939 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
3940 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
3941 possible that the client has already brought one.
3942
3943 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
3944 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
3945 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
3946 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
3947 header and requires different one.
3948
3949 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
3950 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
3951 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
3952 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
3953 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
3954 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
3955 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
3956
3957 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
3958 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
3959 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
3960 both are defined.
3961
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003962 It is important to note that by default, HAProxy works in tunnel mode and
3963 only inspects the first request of a connection, meaning that only the first
3964 request will have the header appended, which is certainly not what you want.
3965 In order to fix this, ensure that any of the "httpclose", "forceclose" or
3966 "http-server-close" options is set when using this option.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003967
3968 Examples :
3969 # Original Destination address
3970 frontend www
3971 mode http
3972 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
3973
3974 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
3975 backend www
3976 mode http
3977 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
3978
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003979 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
3980 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003981
3982
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003983option persist
3984no option persist
3985 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
3986 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3987 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01003988 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003989
3990 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
3991 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
3992 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
3993 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
3994 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
3995 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
3996 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
3997 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
3998 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
3999 redirected to another valid server.
4000
4001 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4002 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4003
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004004 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004005
4006
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004007option redispatch
4008no option redispatch
4009 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
4010 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4011 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004012 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004013
4014 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
4015 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
4016 be able to access the service anymore.
4017
4018 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their
4019 persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
4020
4021 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
4022 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
4023 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004024
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004025 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
4026 "redisp" keywords.
4027
4028 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4029 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4030
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004031 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004032
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004033
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02004034option redis-check
4035 Use redis health checks for server testing
4036 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4037 yes | no | yes | yes
4038 Arguments : none
4039
4040 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
4041 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
4042 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
4043 find the "+PONG" response message.
4044
4045 Example :
4046 option redis-check
4047
4048 See also : "option httpchk"
4049
4050
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004051option smtpchk
4052option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
4053 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
4054 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4055 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004056 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004057 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
4058 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESTMP). All other
4059 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
4060
4061 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
4062 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
4063 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
4064
4065 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
4066 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
4067 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
4068 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
4069 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
4070 dead server.
4071
4072 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
4073 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
4074 so you may want to experiment to improve the behaviour. Using telnet on port
4075 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
4076
4077 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
4078 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
4079 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
4080 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
4081 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in.
4082
4083 Example :
4084 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
4085
4086 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
4087
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004088
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02004089option socket-stats
4090no option socket-stats
4091
4092 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
4093 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4094 yes | yes | yes | no
4095
4096 Arguments : none
4097
4098
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004099option splice-auto
4100no option splice-auto
4101 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
4102 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4103 yes | yes | yes | yes
4104 Arguments : none
4105
4106 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
4107 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
4108 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. Haproxy
4109 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004110 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004111 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
4112 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
4113 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
4114 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
4115
4116 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
4117 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
4118 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
4119 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
4120 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
4121 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
4122 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
4123 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
4124 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
4125 keyword.
4126
4127 Example :
4128 option splice-auto
4129
4130 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4131 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4132
4133 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
4134 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
4135
4136
4137option splice-request
4138no option splice-request
4139 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
4140 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4141 yes | yes | yes | yes
4142 Arguments : none
4143
4144 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004145 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004146 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
4147 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
4148 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
4149 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
4150
4151 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
4152
4153 Example :
4154 option splice-request
4155
4156 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4157 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4158
4159 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
4160 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
4161
4162
4163option splice-response
4164no option splice-response
4165 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
4166 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4167 yes | yes | yes | yes
4168 Arguments : none
4169
4170 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004171 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004172 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
4173 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
4174 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
4175 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
4176
4177 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
4178
4179 Example :
4180 option splice-response
4181
4182 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4183 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4184
4185 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
4186 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
4187
4188
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004189option srvtcpka
4190no option srvtcpka
4191 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
4192 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4193 yes | no | yes | yes
4194 Arguments : none
4195
4196 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
4197 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
4198 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
4199 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
4200
4201 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
4202 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
4203 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
4204 operating system and its tuning parameters.
4205
4206 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
4207 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
4208 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
4209 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
4210 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
4211
4212 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
4213
4214 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
4215 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
4216 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
4217
4218 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4219 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4220
4221 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
4222
4223
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004224option ssl-hello-chk
4225 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
4226 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4227 yes | no | yes | yes
4228 Arguments : none
4229
4230 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
4231 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
4232 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
4233 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
4234 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
4235 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
4236 hello message.
4237
4238 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
4239 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
4240 messages, which is appreciable.
4241
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02004242 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
4243 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
4244 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004245
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02004246 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
4247
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004248
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02004249option tcp-smart-accept
4250no option tcp-smart-accept
4251 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
4252 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4253 yes | yes | yes | no
4254 Arguments : none
4255
4256 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
4257 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
4258 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
4259 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
4260 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
4261 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
4262
4263 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
4264 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
4265 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
4266 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
4267
4268 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
4269 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
4270 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
4271 fall back to normal behaviour by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
4272
4273 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
4274 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
4275 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
4276
4277 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
4278 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
4279 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
4280
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02004281 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
4282
4283
4284option tcp-smart-connect
4285no option tcp-smart-connect
4286 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
4287 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4288 yes | no | yes | yes
4289 Arguments : none
4290
4291 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
4292 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
4293 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
4294 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
4295 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
4296
4297 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
4298 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
4299 complex.
4300
4301 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
4302 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
4303 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
4304
4305 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4306 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4307
4308 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
4309
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02004310
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004311option tcpka
4312 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
4313 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4314 yes | yes | yes | yes
4315 Arguments : none
4316
4317 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
4318 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
4319 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
4320 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
4321
4322 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
4323 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
4324 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
4325 operating system and its tuning parameters.
4326
4327 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
4328 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
4329 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
4330 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
4331 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
4332
4333 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
4334
4335 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
4336 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
4337 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
4338 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
4339 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
4340 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
4341 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
4342 backends.
4343
4344 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
4345
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004346
4347option tcplog
4348 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
4349 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4350 yes | yes | yes | yes
4351 Arguments : none
4352
4353 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
4354 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
4355 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
4356 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
4357 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
4358 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
4359 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
4360 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
4361
4362 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
4363
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004364 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004365
4366
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004367option transparent
4368no option transparent
4369 Enable client-side transparent proxying
4370 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01004371 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004372 Arguments : none
4373
4374 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
4375 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
4376 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
4377 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
4378 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
4379 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
4380 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
4381 appropriate server.
4382
4383 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
4384 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
4385
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01004386 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004387 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004388
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004389
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004390persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02004391persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004392 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
4393 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4394 yes | no | yes | yes
4395 Arguments :
4396 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02004397 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
4398 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004399
4400 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
4401 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
4402 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analysed
4403 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
4404 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
4405 forwarded to this server.
4406
4407 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
4408 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
4409 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004410 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004411 a single "listen" section.
4412
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02004413 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
4414 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
4415 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
4416
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004417 Example :
4418 listen tse-farm
4419 bind :3389
4420 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
4421 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
4422 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
4423 # apply RDP cookie persistence
4424 persist rdp-cookie
4425 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02004426 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004427 balance rdp-cookie
4428 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
4429 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
4430
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09004431 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
4432 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004433
4434
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01004435rate-limit sessions <rate>
4436 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
4437 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4438 yes | yes | yes | no
4439 Arguments :
4440 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
4441 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
4442
4443 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
4444 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
4445 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
4446 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
4447 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
4448 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
4449
4450 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
4451 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
4452 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
4453 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
4454
4455 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
4456 listen smtp
4457 mode tcp
4458 bind :25
4459 rate-limit sessions 10
4460 server 127.0.0.1:1025
4461
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02004462 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
4463 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
4464 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01004465
4466 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
4467
4468
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02004469redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
4470redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
4471redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004472 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
4473 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4474 no | yes | yes | yes
4475
4476 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01004477 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004478
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004479 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02004480 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
4481 the HTTP "Location" header.
4482
4483 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
4484 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
4485 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
4486 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
4487 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
4488 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie).
4489
4490 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
4491 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
4492 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
4493 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
4494 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
4495 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
4496 returned, which most recent browsers interprete as redirecting to
4497 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
4498 HTTPS.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004499
4500 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
4501 is desired. Only codes 301, 302 and 303 are supported, and 302 is
4502 used if no code is specified. 301 means "Moved permanently", and
4503 a browser may cache the Location. 302 means "Moved permanently"
4504 and means that the browser should not cache the redirection. 303
4505 is equivalent to 302 except that the browser will fetch the
4506 location with a GET method.
4507
4508 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
4509 expected behaviour of a redirection :
4510
4511 - "drop-query"
4512 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
4513 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
4514 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
4515 with a location-type redirect.
4516
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01004517 - "append-slash"
4518 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
4519 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
4520 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
4521 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
4522
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004523 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
4524 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
4525 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
4526 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
4527 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
4528 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
4529 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
4530
4531 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
4532 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
4533 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
4534 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
4535 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
4536 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
4537 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004538
4539 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
4540 acl clear dst_port 80
4541 acl secure dst_port 8080
4542 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004543 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01004544 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004545 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
4546
4547 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01004548 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
4549 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
4550 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004551 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004552
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01004553 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
4554 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
4555 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
4556
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02004557 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01004558 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02004559
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004560 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004561
4562
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004563redisp (deprecated)
4564redispatch (deprecated)
4565 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
4566 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4567 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004568 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004569
4570 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
4571 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
4572 be able to access the service anymore.
4573
4574 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
4575 redistribute them to a working server.
4576
4577 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
4578 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
4579 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004580
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004581 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
4582 "option redispatch" instead.
4583
4584 See also : "option redispatch"
4585
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004586
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01004587reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004588 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
4589 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4590 no | yes | yes | yes
4591 Arguments :
4592 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4593 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004594 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004595
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01004596 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4597 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4598
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004599 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
4600 the last header of an HTTP request.
4601
4602 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4603 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4604 responses.
4605
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01004606 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
4607 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
4608 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
4609
4610 See also: "rspadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
4611 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004612
4613
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004614reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4615reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004616 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
4617 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4618 no | yes | yes | yes
4619 Arguments :
4620 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4621 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4622 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4623 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4624 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4625 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
4626 ignores case.
4627
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004628 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4629 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4630
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004631 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4632 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
4633 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
4634 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004635 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004636
4637 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4638 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
4639
4640 Example :
4641 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
4642 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
4643 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
4644
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004645 See also: "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and
4646 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004647
4648
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004649reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4650reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004651 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
4652 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4653 no | yes | yes | yes
4654 Arguments :
4655 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4656 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4657 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4658 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4659 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
4660 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
4661
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004662 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4663 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4664
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004665 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
4666 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
4667 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
4668 next servers.
4669
4670 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4671 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4672 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
4673
4674 Example :
4675 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
4676 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
4677 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
4678
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004679 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", section 6 about HTTP header
4680 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004681
4682
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004683reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4684reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004685 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
4686 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4687 no | yes | yes | yes
4688 Arguments :
4689 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4690 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4691 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4692 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4693 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4694 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
4695 case.
4696
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004697 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4698 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4699
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004700 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4701 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
4702 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
4703 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004704 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004705
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004706 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004707 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004708 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004709
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004710 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4711 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
4712
4713 Example :
4714 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
4715 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
4716 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
4717
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004718 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
4719 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004720
4721
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004722reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4723reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004724 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
4725 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4726 no | yes | yes | yes
4727 Arguments :
4728 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4729 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4730 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4731 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4732 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4733 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
4734 case.
4735
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004736 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4737 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4738
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004739 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4740 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
4741 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
4742 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
4743
4744 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4745 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
4746
4747 Example :
4748 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
4749 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
4750 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
4751 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
4752
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004753 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
4754 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004755
4756
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004757reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4758reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004759 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
4760 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4761 no | yes | yes | yes
4762 Arguments :
4763 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4764 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4765 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4766 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4767 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
4768 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
4769
4770 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4771 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
4772 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
4773 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004774 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004775
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004776 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4777 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4778
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004779 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
4780 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
4781 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
4782
4783 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4784 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4785 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
4786 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
4787 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
4788
4789 Example :
4790 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04004791 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004792 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
4793 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
4794
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04004795 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", "tune.bufsize", section 6 about
4796 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004797
4798
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004799reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4800reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004801 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
4802 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4803 no | yes | yes | yes
4804 Arguments :
4805 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4806 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4807 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4808 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4809 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4810 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
4811 ignores case.
4812
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004813 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4814 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4815
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004816 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4817 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004818 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
4819 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
4820 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004821 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
4822 not set.
4823
4824 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
4825 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
4826 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
4827 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
4828 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
4829
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004830 Examples :
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004831 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavour of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
4832 # block all others.
4833 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
4834 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
4835
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004836 # block bad guys
4837 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
4838 reqitarpit . if badguys
4839
4840 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", section 6 about HTTP header
4841 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004842
4843
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02004844retries <value>
4845 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
4846 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4847 yes | no | yes | yes
4848 Arguments :
4849 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
4850 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
4851 default value is 3.
4852
4853 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
4854 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
4855 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
4856
4857 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
4858 a turn-around timer of 1 second is applied before a retry occurs.
4859
4860 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
4861 server even if a cookie references a different server.
4862
4863 See also : "option redispatch"
4864
4865
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004866rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004867 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
4868 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4869 no | yes | yes | yes
4870 Arguments :
4871 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4872 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004873 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004874
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004875 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4876 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4877
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004878 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
4879 the last header of an HTTP response.
4880
4881 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4882 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4883 responses.
4884
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004885 See also: "reqadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
4886 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004887
4888
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004889rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4890rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004891 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
4892 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4893 no | yes | yes | yes
4894 Arguments :
4895 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4896 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
4897 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
4898 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
4899 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
4900 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
4901 ignores case.
4902
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004903 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4904 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4905
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004906 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
4907 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02004908 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004909 client.
4910
4911 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4912 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4913 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
4914
4915 Example :
4916 # remove the Server header from responses
4917 reqidel ^Server:.*
4918
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004919 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", section 6 about HTTP header
4920 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004921
4922
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004923rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4924rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004925 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
4926 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4927 no | yes | yes | yes
4928 Arguments :
4929 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4930 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
4931 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
4932 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
4933 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
4934 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
4935 ignores case.
4936
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004937 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4938 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4939
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004940 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4941 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
4942 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
4943 case-sensitive.
4944
4945 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004946 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
4947 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
4948 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004949
4950 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4951 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
4952
4953 Example :
4954 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
4955 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
4956
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004957 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation
4958 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004959
4960
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004961rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4962rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004963 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
4964 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4965 no | yes | yes | yes
4966 Arguments :
4967 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4968 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
4969 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
4970 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
4971 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
4972 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
4973 ignores case.
4974
4975 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4976 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
4977 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
4978 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004979 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004980
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004981 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4982 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4983
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004984 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
4985 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
4986 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
4987
4988 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4989 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4990 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
4991 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
4992 are not case-sensitive.
4993
4994 Example :
4995 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
4996 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
4997
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004998 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", section 6 about HTTP header
4999 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005000
5001
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01005002server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005003 Declare a server in a backend
5004 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5005 no | no | yes | yes
5006 Arguments :
5007 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Cyril Bonté941a0c62012-10-15 19:44:24 +02005008 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005009 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005010
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01005011 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
5012 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
5013 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
5014 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02005015 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
5016 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
5017 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
5018 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
5019 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
5020 to report statistics.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005021
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02005022 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005023 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
5024 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
5025 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
5026 adding this value to the client's port.
5027
5028 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
5029 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005030 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005031
5032 Examples :
5033 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
5034 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
5035
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005036 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
5037 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005038
5039
5040source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005041source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01005042source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005043 Set the source address for outgoing connections
5044 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5045 yes | no | yes | yes
5046 Arguments :
5047 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
5048 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
5049 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
5050 the most appropriate address to reach its destination.
5051
5052 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
5053 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02005054 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
5055 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
5056 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005057
5058 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
5059 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
5060 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
5061 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
5062 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
5063 <addr>.
5064
5065 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
5066 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
5067 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
5068 port.
5069
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005070 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
5071 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
5072 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
5073 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
5074 and to automatically bind to the the client's IP address as seen
5075 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
5076 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
5077 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
5078 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
5079 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
5080 HTTP header.
5081
5082 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
5083 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005084 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005085 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
5086 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
5087 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
5088 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
5089 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
5090 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
5091 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
5092
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01005093 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
5094 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
5095 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
5096 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
5097 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
5098 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
5099
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005100 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
5101 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
5102 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
5103 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
5104
5105 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
5106 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
5107 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
5108 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
5109 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
5110 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
5111
5112 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
5113 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
5114 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
5115 there are two methods :
5116
5117 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
5118 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
5119 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
5120 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
5121 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
5122 of the client ranges may be used.
5123
5124 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
5125 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
5126 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
5127 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
5128 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
5129 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
5130 same session.
5131
5132 Note that depending on the transparent proxy technology used, it may be
5133 required to force the source address. In fact, cttproxy version 2 requires an
5134 IP address in <addr> above, and does not support setting of "0.0.0.0" as the
5135 IP address because it creates NAT entries which much match the exact outgoing
5136 address. Tproxy version 4 and some other kernel patches which work in pure
5137 forwarding mode generally will not have this limitation.
5138
5139 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
5140 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
5141 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005142 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005143
5144 Examples :
5145 backend private
5146 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
5147 source 192.168.1.200
5148
5149 backend transparent_ssl1
5150 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
5151 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
5152
5153 backend transparent_ssl2
5154 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
5155 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
5156 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
5157
5158 backend transparent_ssl3
5159 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
5160 # is more conntrack-friendly.
5161 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
5162
5163 backend transparent_smtp
5164 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
5165 # with Tproxy version 4.
5166 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
5167
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005168 backend transparent_http
5169 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
5170 # proxy.
5171 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
5172
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005173 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005174 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
5175
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005176
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005177srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
5178 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
5179 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5180 yes | no | yes | yes
5181 Arguments :
5182 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
5183 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
5184 as explained at the top of this document.
5185
5186 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
5187 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
5188 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
5189 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
5190 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
5191 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
5192 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
5193
5194 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
5195 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
5196 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
5197 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
5198 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005199 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005200 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005201 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005202
5203 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
5204 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
5205 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
5206 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
5207 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
5208 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
5209
5210 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
5211 Please use "timeout server" instead.
5212
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02005213 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
5214 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005215
5216
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02005217stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
5218 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
5219 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5220 no | no | yes | yes
5221
5222 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
5223 matched.
5224
5225 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
5226 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
5227
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005228 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5229 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5230 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5231
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01005232 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
5233 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
5234 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
5235 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02005236
5237 Example :
5238 # statistics admin level only for localhost
5239 backend stats_localhost
5240 stats enable
5241 stats admin if LOCALHOST
5242
5243 Example :
5244 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
5245 backend stats_auth
5246 stats enable
5247 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
5248 stats admin if TRUE
5249
5250 Example :
5251 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
5252 userlist stats-auth
5253 group admin users admin
5254 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
5255 group readonly users haproxy
5256 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
5257
5258 backend stats_auth
5259 stats enable
5260 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
5261 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
5262 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
5263 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
5264
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005265 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
5266 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
5267 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02005268
5269
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005270stats auth <user>:<passwd>
5271 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
5272 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5273 yes | no | yes | yes
5274 Arguments :
5275 <user> is a user name to grant access to
5276
5277 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
5278
5279 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
5280 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
5281 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
5282 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
5283 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
5284 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
5285
5286 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
5287 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
5288 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02005289 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005290
5291 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
5292 report using "stats scope".
5293
5294 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5295 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5296 unobvious parameters.
5297
5298 Example :
5299 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5300 backend public_www
5301 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5302 stats enable
5303 stats hide-version
5304 stats scope .
5305 stats uri /admin?stats
5306 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5307 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5308 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5309
5310 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5311 backend private_monitoring
5312 stats enable
5313 stats uri /admin?stats
5314 stats refresh 5s
5315
5316 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
5317
5318
5319stats enable
5320 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
5321 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5322 yes | no | yes | yes
5323 Arguments : none
5324
5325 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
5326 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
5327 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
5328 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
5329 - stats auth : no authentication
5330 - stats scope : no restriction
5331
5332 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5333 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5334 unobvious parameters.
5335
5336 Example :
5337 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5338 backend public_www
5339 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5340 stats enable
5341 stats hide-version
5342 stats scope .
5343 stats uri /admin?stats
5344 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5345 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5346 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5347
5348 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5349 backend private_monitoring
5350 stats enable
5351 stats uri /admin?stats
5352 stats refresh 5s
5353
5354 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
5355
5356
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005357stats hide-version
5358 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005359 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5360 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005361 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005362
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005363 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
5364 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
5365 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
5366 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
5367 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
5368 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005369
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02005370 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5371 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5372 unobvious parameters.
5373
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005374 Example :
5375 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5376 backend public_www
5377 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02005378 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005379 stats hide-version
5380 stats scope .
5381 stats uri /admin?stats
5382 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5383 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5384 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005385
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005386 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5387 backend private_monitoring
5388 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005389 stats uri /admin?stats
5390 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01005391
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005392 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005393
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01005394
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02005395stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
5396 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5397 Access control for statistics
5398
5399 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5400 no | no | yes | yes
5401
5402 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
5403 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
5404 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
5405 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
5406 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
5407 should be asked to enter a username and password.
5408
5409 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
5410 instance.
5411
5412 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
5413 about ACL usage.
5414
5415
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005416stats realm <realm>
5417 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
5418 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5419 yes | no | yes | yes
5420 Arguments :
5421 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
5422 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
5423 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
5424
5425 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
5426 using a backslash ('\').
5427
5428 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
5429 only related to authentication.
5430
5431 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5432 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5433 unobvious parameters.
5434
5435 Example :
5436 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5437 backend public_www
5438 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5439 stats enable
5440 stats hide-version
5441 stats scope .
5442 stats uri /admin?stats
5443 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5444 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5445 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5446
5447 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5448 backend private_monitoring
5449 stats enable
5450 stats uri /admin?stats
5451 stats refresh 5s
5452
5453 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
5454
5455
5456stats refresh <delay>
5457 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
5458 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5459 yes | no | yes | yes
5460 Arguments :
5461 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
5462 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
5463 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
5464 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
5465 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
5466 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
5467
5468 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
5469 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
5470 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
5471 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
5472
5473 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5474 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5475 unobvious parameters.
5476
5477 Example :
5478 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5479 backend public_www
5480 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5481 stats enable
5482 stats hide-version
5483 stats scope .
5484 stats uri /admin?stats
5485 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5486 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5487 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5488
5489 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5490 backend private_monitoring
5491 stats enable
5492 stats uri /admin?stats
5493 stats refresh 5s
5494
5495 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
5496
5497
5498stats scope { <name> | "." }
5499 Enable statistics and limit access scope
5500 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5501 yes | no | yes | yes
5502 Arguments :
5503 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
5504 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
5505 section in which the statement appears.
5506
5507 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
5508 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
5509 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
5510 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
5511 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
5512 exists.
5513
5514 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5515 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5516 unobvious parameters.
5517
5518 Example :
5519 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5520 backend public_www
5521 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5522 stats enable
5523 stats hide-version
5524 stats scope .
5525 stats uri /admin?stats
5526 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5527 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5528 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5529
5530 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5531 backend private_monitoring
5532 stats enable
5533 stats uri /admin?stats
5534 stats refresh 5s
5535
5536 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
5537
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005538
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005539stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005540 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
5541 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5542 yes | no | yes | yes
5543
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005544 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005545 description from global section is automatically used instead.
5546
5547 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
5548 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
5549
5550 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5551 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04005552 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005553
5554 Example :
5555 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5556 backend private_monitoring
5557 stats enable
5558 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
5559 stats uri /admin?stats
5560 stats refresh 5s
5561
5562 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
5563 global section.
5564
5565
5566stats show-legends
5567 Enable reporting additional informations on the statistics page :
5568 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
5569 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
5570 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
5571 - IP (socket, server)
5572 - cookie (backend, server)
5573
5574 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5575 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04005576 unobvious parameters. Default behaviour is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005577
5578 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
5579
5580
5581stats show-node [ <name> ]
5582 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
5583 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5584 yes | no | yes | yes
5585 Arguments:
5586 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
5587 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
5588
5589 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
5590 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04005591 provided for each customer. Default behaviour is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005592
5593 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5594 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5595 unobvious parameters.
5596
5597 Example:
5598 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5599 backend private_monitoring
5600 stats enable
5601 stats show-node Europe-1
5602 stats uri /admin?stats
5603 stats refresh 5s
5604
5605 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
5606 section.
5607
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005608
5609stats uri <prefix>
5610 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
5611 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5612 yes | no | yes | yes
5613 Arguments :
5614 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
5615 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
5616 query string.
5617
5618 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
5619 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
5620 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
5621 possible to reach it in the application.
5622
5623 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005624 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005625 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
5626 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
5627 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
5628 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
5629
5630 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
5631 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
5632 an address or a port to statistics only.
5633
5634 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5635 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5636 unobvious parameters.
5637
5638 Example :
5639 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5640 backend public_www
5641 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5642 stats enable
5643 stats hide-version
5644 stats scope .
5645 stats uri /admin?stats
5646 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5647 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5648 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5649
5650 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5651 backend private_monitoring
5652 stats enable
5653 stats uri /admin?stats
5654 stats refresh 5s
5655
5656 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
5657
5658
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005659stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
5660 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005661 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005662 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005663
5664 Arguments :
5665 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.8. It
5666 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
5667 will be analysed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
5668 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
5669
5670 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
5671 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
5672 the "stick-table" statement.
5673
5674 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
5675 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
5676 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
5677 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
5678 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
5679
5680 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
5681 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
5682 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
5683 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
5684 transformation rules.
5685
5686 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
5687 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
5688 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
5689 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
5690 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
5691 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
5692 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
5693
5694 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
5695 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
5696 ACL based conditions.
5697
5698 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
5699 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
5700 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
5701 matches can be used as fallbacks.
5702
5703 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
5704 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
5705 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
5706 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
5707
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005708 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5709 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5710 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5711
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005712 Example :
5713 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
5714 # last 30 minutes
5715 backend pop
5716 mode tcp
5717 balance roundrobin
5718 stick store-request src
5719 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
5720 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
5721 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
5722
5723 backend smtp
5724 mode tcp
5725 balance roundrobin
5726 stick match src table pop
5727 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
5728 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
5729
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005730 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
5731 about ACLs and pattern extraction.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005732
5733
5734stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
5735 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
5736 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5737 no | no | yes | yes
5738
5739 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
5740 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
5741 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
5742 for writing more maintainable configurations.
5743
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005744 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5745 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5746 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5747
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005748 Examples :
5749 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01005750 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005751
5752 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
5753 stick match src table pop if !localhost
5754 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
5755
5756
5757 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
5758 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
5759 backend http
5760 mode http
5761 balance roundrobin
5762 stick on src table https
5763 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
5764 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
5765 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
5766
5767 backend https
5768 mode tcp
5769 balance roundrobin
5770 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
5771 stick on src
5772 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
5773 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
5774
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005775 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005776
5777
5778stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
5779 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
5780 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5781 no | no | yes | yes
5782
5783 Arguments :
5784 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.8. It
5785 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
5786 will be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
5787 server is selected.
5788
5789 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
5790 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
5791 the "stick-table" statement.
5792
5793 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
5794 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
5795 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
5796 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
5797 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
5798 address.
5799
5800 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
5801 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
5802 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
5803 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
5804 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
5805 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
5806 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
5807 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
5808 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
5809 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
5810
5811 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
5812 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
5813 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
5814 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
5815 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
5816 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
5817 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
5818
5819 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
5820 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
5821 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
5822 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
5823
5824 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
5825 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
5826 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
5827 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
5828 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
5829 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
5830 another protocol or access method.
5831
5832 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
5833 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
5834 the request.
5835
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005836 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5837 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5838 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5839
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005840 Example :
5841 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
5842 # last 30 minutes
5843 backend pop
5844 mode tcp
5845 balance roundrobin
5846 stick store-request src
5847 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
5848 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
5849 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
5850
5851 backend smtp
5852 mode tcp
5853 balance roundrobin
5854 stick match src table pop
5855 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
5856 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
5857
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005858 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
5859 about ACLs and pattern extraction.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005860
5861
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02005862stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02005863 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
5864 [store <data_type>]*
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005865 Configure the stickiness table for the current backend
5866 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02005867 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005868
5869 Arguments :
5870 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
5871 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
5872 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
5873 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
5874
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01005875 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
5876 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
5877 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
5878 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
5879
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005880 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
5881 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
5882 instance.
5883
5884 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
5885 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
5886 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
5887 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
5888 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
5889 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02005890 to 32 characters.
5891
5892 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
5893 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
5894 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
5895 being stored. If the block provided by the pattern extractor
5896 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
5897 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005898
5899 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02005900 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
5901 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005902 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
5903 increase.
5904
5905 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01005906 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
5907 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
5908 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005909
5910 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
5911 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
5912 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
5913 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
5914 most often the desired behaviour. In some specific cases, it
5915 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
5916 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
5917 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
5918 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
5919 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
5920 parameter (see below).
5921
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02005922 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
5923 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
5924 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
5925 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
5926 soft restart.
5927
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005928 NOTE : peers can't be used in multi-process mode.
5929
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005930 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
5931 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
5932 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
5933 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
5934 section 2.2 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02005935 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005936 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
5937 if not expiration delay is specified.
5938
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02005939 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
5940 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
5941 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
5942 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005943 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
5944 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
5945 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
5946 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
5947 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
5948 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
5949 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
5950 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
5951 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
5952 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
5953 types and their arguments.
5954
5955 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
5956 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
5957 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
5958 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
5959
5960 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
5961 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
5962 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
5963 specific behaviour was detected and must be known for future matches.
5964
5965 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
5966 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
5967 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
5968 they were received.
5969
5970 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
5971 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
5972 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
5973 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
5974 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
5975
5976 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5977 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5978 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5979 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
5980 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
5981
5982 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
5983 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
5984 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
5985
5986 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5987 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5988 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5989 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
5990 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
5991
5992 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
5993 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
5994 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
5995 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
5996 the client side.
5997
5998 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5999 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6000 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6001 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
6002 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
6003 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
6004 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
6005
6006 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
6007 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
6008 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
6009 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
6010 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
6011 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
6012 (eg: vulnerability scan).
6013
6014 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6015 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6016 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6017 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
6018 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
6019 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
6020
6021 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
6022 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes received from clients
6023 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
6024 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
6025
6026 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6027 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6028 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6029 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
6030 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
6031 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
6032 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
6033 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
6034 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
6035 recommended for better fairness.
6036
6037 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
6038 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes sent to clients which
6039 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
6040 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
6041
6042 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
6043 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6044 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6045 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
6046 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
6047 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
6048 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
6049 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
6050 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
6051 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02006052
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02006053 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
6054 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006055 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
6056 reference it.
6057
6058 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
6059 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
6060 lost upon restart. In general it can be good as a complement but not always
6061 as an exclusive stickiness.
6062
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006063 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
6064 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
6065 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
6066 something that can be ignored.
6067
6068 Example:
6069 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
6070 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
6071 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
6072 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
6073
6074 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.2
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01006075 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006076
6077
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006078stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
6079 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
6080 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6081 no | no | yes | yes
6082
6083 Arguments :
6084 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.8. It
6085 describes what elements of the response or connection will
6086 be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
6087 server is selected.
6088
6089 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
6090 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
6091 the "stick-table" statement.
6092
6093 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
6094 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
6095 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
6096 when the response is a SSL server hello.
6097
6098 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
6099 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
6100 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
6101 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
6102 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
6103 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006104 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006105 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
6106 rules.
6107
6108 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
6109 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
6110 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
6111 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
6112 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
6113 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
6114 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
6115
6116 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
6117 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
6118 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
6119 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
6120
6121 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
6122 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
6123 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
6124 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
6125 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
6126 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
6127 another protocol or access method.
6128
6129 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
6130
6131 Example :
6132 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
6133 backend https
6134 mode tcp
6135 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02006136 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006137 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006138
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006139 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
6140 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
6141
6142 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
6143 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
6144 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
6145
6146 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
6147 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006148
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006149 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
6150 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
6151 # at offset 44.
6152
6153 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
6154 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
6155
6156 # Learn on response if server hello.
6157 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02006158
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006159 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
6160 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
6161
6162 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
6163 extraction.
6164
6165
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006166tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6167 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02006168 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6169 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006170 Arguments :
6171 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
6172 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc1", "track-sc2".
6173 See below for more details.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02006174
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006175 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006176
6177 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
6178 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006179 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
6180 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
6181 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
6182 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
6183 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
6184 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006185
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006186 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
6187 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
6188 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
6189 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006190
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006191 Three types of actions are supported :
6192 - accept :
6193 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6194 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
6195 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006196
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006197 - reject :
6198 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6199 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
6200 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
6201 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
6202 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
6203 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
6204 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
6205 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
6206 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
6207 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
6208 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
6209 be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006210
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006211 - { track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
6212 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
6213 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. Two sets
6214 of counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The
6215 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
6216 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
6217 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
6218 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
6219 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006220
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006221 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01006222 <key> is mandatory, and is a pattern extraction rule as described
6223 in section 7.8. It describes what elements of the incoming
6224 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
6225 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
6226 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
6227 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006228
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006229 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
6230 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
6231 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
6232 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006233
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006234 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
6235 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
6236 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
6237 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
6238 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01006239 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
6240 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
6241 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
6242 layer7 information is extracted.
6243
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006244 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
6245 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
6246 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
6247 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
6248 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006249
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006250 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
6251 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
6252 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006253
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006254 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
6255 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
6256 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006257
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006258 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006259 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006260 tcp-request connection track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006261
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006262 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
6263 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
6264 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006265
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006266 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
6267 tcp-request connection track-sc1 src
6268 tcp-request connection reject if { sc1_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006269
6270 See section 7 about ACL usage.
6271
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006272 See also : "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006273
6274
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006275tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6276 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006277 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02006278 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006279 Arguments :
6280 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
6281 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc1", "track-sc2".
6282 See "tcp-request connection" above for their signification.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006283
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006284 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006285
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006286 A request's contents can be analysed at an early stage of request processing
6287 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
6288 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
6289 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
6290 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006291
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006292 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
6293 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
6294 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
6295 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
6296 both frontends and backends. In frontends, they will be evaluated upon new
6297 connections. In backends, they will be evaluated once a session is assigned
6298 a backend. This means that a single frontend connection may be evaluated
6299 several times by one or multiple backends when a session gets reassigned
6300 (for instance after a client-side HTTP keep-alive request).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006301
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006302 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
6303 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
6304 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
6305 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006306
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006307 Three types of actions are supported :
6308 - accept :
6309 - reject :
6310 - { track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006311
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006312 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
6313 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006314
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006315 Also, it is worth noting that if sticky counters are tracked from a rule
6316 defined in a backend, this tracking will automatically end when the session
6317 releases the backend. That allows per-backend counter tracking even in case
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01006318 of HTTP keep-alive requests when the backend changes. This makes a subtle
6319 difference because tracking rules in "frontend" and "listen" section last for
6320 all the session, as opposed to the backend rules. The difference appears when
6321 some layer 7 information is tracked. While there is nothing mandatory about
6322 it, it is recommended to use the track-sc1 pointer to track per-frontend
6323 counters and track-sc2 to track per-backend counters.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006324
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006325 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006326 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
6327 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006328
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006329 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02006330 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
6331 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
6332 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
6333 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
6334 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006335
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01006336 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
6337 are present when the rule is processed. The current solution for making the
6338 rule engine wait for such information is to set an inspect delay and to
6339 condition its execution with an ACL relying on such information.
6340
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006341 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006342 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
6343 # and reject everything else.
6344 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
6345 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02006346 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006347 tcp-request content reject
6348
6349 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006350 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
6351 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
6352 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006353 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006354
6355 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
6356 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
6357 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006358 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006359 tcp-request content reject
6360
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01006361 Example:
6362 # Track the last IP from X-Forwarded-For
6363 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
6364 tcp-request content track-sc1 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1) if HTTP
6365
6366 Example:
6367 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
6368 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
6369 tcp-request content track-sc1 base table req-rate if HTTP
6370
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006371 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
6372 frontend when the backend detects abuse.
6373
6374 frontend http
6375 # Use General Purpose Couter 0 in SC1 as a global abuse counter
6376 # protecting all our sites
6377 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
6378 tcp-request connection track-sc1 src
6379 tcp-request connection reject if { sc1_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
6380 ...
6381 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
6382
6383 backend http_dynamic
6384 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
6385 # by SC2), block it globally in the frontend.
6386 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
6387 acl click_too_fast sc2_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01006388 acl mark_as_abuser sc1_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006389 tcp-request content track-sc2 src
6390 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006391
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006392 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006393
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006394 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request inspect-delay"
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006395
6396
6397tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
6398 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
6399 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02006400 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006401 Arguments :
6402 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6403 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6404 as explained at the top of this document.
6405
6406 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
6407 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
6408 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
6409 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
6410 data for at most the specified amount of time.
6411
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02006412 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
6413 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
6414 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
6415 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
6416
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006417 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
6418 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006419 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006420 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01006421 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
6422 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
6423 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
6424 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006425
6426 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
6427 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
6428 it pass through unaffected.
6429
6430 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
6431 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
6432 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006433 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006434 before the server (eg: SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
6435 data to the server (eg: SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02006436 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
6437 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
6438 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006439
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006440 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006441 "timeout client".
6442
6443
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02006444tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6445 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
6446 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6447 no | no | yes | yes
6448 Arguments :
6449 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
6450 actions include : "accept", "reject".
6451 See "tcp-request connection" above for their signification.
6452
6453 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
6454
6455 Response contents can be analysed at an early stage of response processing
6456 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
6457 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
6458 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection delay is
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006459 set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02006460
6461 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
6462
6463 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
6464 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
6465 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
6466 inserted.
6467
6468 Two types of actions are supported :
6469 - accept :
6470 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6471 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
6472 the rules evaluation.
6473
6474 - reject :
6475 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6476 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006477 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02006478
6479 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
6480 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
6481 for changing the default action to a reject.
6482
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006483 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
6484 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
6485 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
6486 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02006487 period.
6488
6489 See section 7 about ACL usage.
6490
6491 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
6492
6493
6494tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
6495 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
6496 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6497 no | no | yes | yes
6498 Arguments :
6499 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6500 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6501 as explained at the top of this document.
6502
6503 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
6504
6505
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006506timeout check <timeout>
6507 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
6508 established.
6509
6510 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6511 yes | no | yes | yes
6512 Arguments:
6513 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6514 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6515 as explained at the top of this document.
6516
6517 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
6518 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
6519 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (eg. those
6520 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +01006521 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
6522 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
6523 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006524
6525 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
6526 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
6527
6528 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
6529 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01006530 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006531
6532 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6533 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6534 forget about it.
6535
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01006536 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
6537 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006538
6539
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006540timeout client <timeout>
6541timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6542 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
6543 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6544 yes | yes | yes | no
6545 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006546 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006547 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6548 as explained at the top of this document.
6549
6550 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
6551 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
6552 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
6553 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
6554 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
6555 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
6556 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
6557 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006558 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006559 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006560 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
6561 sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
6562 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006563
6564 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
6565 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6566 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6567 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6568 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
6569 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6570
6571 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
6572 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
6573 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
6574
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006575 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006576
6577
6578timeout connect <timeout>
6579timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6580 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
6581 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6582 yes | no | yes | yes
6583 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006584 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006585 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6586 as explained at the top of this document.
6587
6588 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006589 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006590 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006591 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006592 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
6593 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006594
6595 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6596 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6597 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6598 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6599 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
6600 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6601
6602 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
6603 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
6604 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
6605
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01006606 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
6607 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006608
6609
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006610timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
6611 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
6612 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6613 yes | yes | yes | yes
6614 Arguments :
6615 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6616 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6617 as explained at the top of this document.
6618
6619 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
6620 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
6621 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
6622 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
6623 once the request has started to present itself.
6624
6625 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
6626 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
6627 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
6628 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
6629 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
6630
6631 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
6632 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
6633 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
6634 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
6635
6636 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
6637 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
6638 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (eg:
6639 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
6640 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02006641 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006642
6643 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
6644 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
6645 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
6646 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
6647
6648 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
6649
6650
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006651timeout http-request <timeout>
6652 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
6653 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02006654 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006655 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006656 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006657 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6658 as explained at the top of this document.
6659
6660 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
6661 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
6662 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
6663 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
6664 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
6665 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
6666 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
6667 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time.
6668
6669 Note that this timeout only applies to the header part of the request, and
6670 not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is not
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006671 used anymore. It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
6672 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006673
6674 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
6675 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
6676 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (eg: 50 ms) will
6677 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
6678 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
6679
6680 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02006681 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
6682 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
6683 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006684
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006685 See also : "timeout http-keep-alive", "timeout client".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006686
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006687
6688timeout queue <timeout>
6689 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
6690 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6691 yes | no | yes | yes
6692 Arguments :
6693 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6694 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6695 as explained at the top of this document.
6696
6697 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
6698 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
6699 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
6700 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
6701 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
6702
6703 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
6704 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
6705 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
6706 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
6707
6708 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
6709
6710
6711timeout server <timeout>
6712timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6713 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
6714 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6715 yes | no | yes | yes
6716 Arguments :
6717 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6718 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6719 as explained at the top of this document.
6720
6721 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
6722 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
6723 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
6724 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
6725 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
6726 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
6727 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
6728
6729 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
6730 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
6731 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
6732 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
6733 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006734 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006735 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006736 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
6737 with short-lived sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
6738 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
6739 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006740
6741 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6742 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6743 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6744 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6745 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
6746 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6747
6748 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
6749 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
6750 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
6751
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006752 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006753
6754
6755timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006756 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006757 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6758 yes | yes | yes | yes
6759 Arguments :
6760 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
6761 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6762 as explained at the top of this document.
6763
6764 When a connection is tarpitted using "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with
6765 no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit"
6766 defines how long it will be maintained open.
6767
6768 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
6769 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
6770 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
6771 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006772 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006773
6774 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
6775
6776
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006777timeout tunnel <timeout>
6778 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
6779 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6780 yes | no | yes | yes
6781 Arguments :
6782 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6783 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6784 as explained at the top of this document.
6785
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006786 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006787 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
6788 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
6789 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
6790 analyser remains attached to either connection (eg: tcp content rules are
6791 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (eg:
6792 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
6793 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
6794 specified.
6795
6796 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
6797 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
6798 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
6799 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
6800 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
6801
6802 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6803 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6804 forget about it.
6805
6806 Example :
6807 defaults http
6808 option http-server-close
6809 timeout connect 5s
6810 timeout client 30s
6811 timeout client 30s
6812 timeout server 30s
6813 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
6814
6815 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server".
6816
6817
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006818transparent (deprecated)
6819 Enable client-side transparent proxying
6820 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01006821 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006822 Arguments : none
6823
6824 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
6825 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
6826 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
6827 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
6828 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
6829 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
6830 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
6831 appropriate server.
6832
6833 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
6834
6835 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
6836 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
6837
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006838 See also: "option transparent"
6839
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006840unique-id-format <string>
6841 Generate a unique ID for each request.
6842 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6843 yes | yes | yes | no
6844 Arguments :
6845 <string> is a log-format string.
6846
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006847 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
6848 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
6849 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
6850 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006851
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006852 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
6853 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
6854 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
6855 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
6856 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
6857 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
6858 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
6859 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006860
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006861 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
6862 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006863
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006864 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006865
6866 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %Ci:%Cp_%Fi:%Fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
6867
6868 will generate:
6869
6870 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
6871
6872 See also: "unique-id-header"
6873
6874unique-id-header <name>
6875 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
6876 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6877 yes | yes | yes | no
6878 Arguments :
6879 <name> is the name of the header.
6880
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006881 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
6882 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006883
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006884 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006885
6886 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %Ci:%Cp_%Fi:%Fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
6887 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
6888
6889 will generate:
6890
6891 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
6892
6893 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006894
6895use_backend <backend> if <condition>
6896use_backend <backend> unless <condition>
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02006897 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006898 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6899 no | yes | yes | no
6900 Arguments :
6901 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section.
6902
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006903 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006904
6905 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
6906 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
6907 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02006908 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
6909 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (eg:
6910 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
6911 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006912
6913 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
6914 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
6915 assign the backend.
6916
6917 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
6918 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
6919 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
6920 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
6921 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
6922 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
6923
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02006924 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006925 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02006926 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
6927 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
6928 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
6929
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02006930 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006931
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006932
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02006933use-server <server> if <condition>
6934use-server <server> unless <condition>
6935 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
6936 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6937 no | no | yes | yes
6938 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006939 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02006940
6941 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
6942
6943 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
6944 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
6945 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
6946
6947 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
6948 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
6949 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
6950 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
6951 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
6952 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
6953 matches will assign the server.
6954
6955 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
6956 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
6957 with the next rules until one matches.
6958
6959 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
6960 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
6961 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
6962 according to other persistence mechanisms.
6963
6964 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
6965 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
6966 stripped.
6967
6968 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
6969 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
6970 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
6971 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
6972
6973 Example :
6974 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
6975 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
6976 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
6977 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
6978 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
6979 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
6980 server mail 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
6981 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
6982 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
6983
6984 See also: "use_backend", serction 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
6985
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02006986
69875. Bind and Server options
6988--------------------------
6989
6990The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
6991depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
6992settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
6993written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
6994described in this section.
6995
6996
69975.1. Bind options
6998-----------------
6999
7000The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
7001as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
7002no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
7003parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
7004while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
7005provided immediately after the setting name.
7006
7007The currently supported settings are the following ones.
7008
7009accept-proxy
7010 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
7011 the sockets declared on the same line. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
7012 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
7013 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
7014 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
7015 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
7016 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
7017 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
7018 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
7019 usable.
7020
7021backlog <backlog>
7022 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified, the frontend's
7023 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
7024
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02007025ecdhe <named curve>
7026 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
7027 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys and makes
7028 ECDHE cipher suites usable.
7029
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02007030ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02007031 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7032 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
7033 client's certificate.
7034
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02007035ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
7036 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
7037 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
7038 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
7039 error is ignored.
7040
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007041ciphers <ciphers>
7042 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
7043 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
7044 negociated during the SSL/TLS handshake. The format of the string is defined
7045 in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string
7046 such as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes).
7047
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02007048crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02007049 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7050 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
7051 to verify client's certificate.
7052
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007053crt <cert>
7054 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
7055 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
7056 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +02007057 files into one. If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters
7058 present in this file are also loaded. If a directory name is used instead of a
7059 PEM file, then all files found in that directory will be loaded. This
7060 directive may be specified multiple times in order to load certificates from
7061 multiple files or directories. The certificates will be presented to clients
7062 who provide a valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their CN
7063 or alt subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*' is
7064 used instead of the first hostname component (eg: *.example.org matches
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007065 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org). If no SNI is provided by the
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +02007066 client or if the SSL library does not support TLS extensions, or if the client
7067 provides and SNI which does not match any certificate, then the first loaded
7068 certificate will be presented. This means that when loading certificates from
7069 a directory, it is highly recommended to load the default one first as a file.
7070 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007071
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02007072crt-ignore-err <errors>
7073 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
7074 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0.
7075 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not abored if an
7076 error is ignored.
7077
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007078defer-accept
7079 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
7080 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
7081 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
7082 for which the client talks first (eg: HTTP). It can slightly improve
7083 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
7084 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
7085 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
7086 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
7087 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
7088 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
7089 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
7090
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02007091force-sslv3
7092 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instanciated from
7093 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
7094 for high connection rates. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
7095
7096force-tlsv10
7097 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instanciated from
7098 this listener. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
7099
7100force-tlsv11
7101 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instanciated from
7102 this listener. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
7103
7104force-tlsv12
7105 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instanciated from
7106 this listener. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
7107
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007108gid <gid>
7109 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
7110 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
7111 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
7112 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
7113 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
7114
7115group <group>
7116 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
7117 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
7118 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
7119 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
7120 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
7121
7122id <id>
7123 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
7124 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
7125 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
7126 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
7127
7128interface <interface>
7129 Sets the name of the network interface to listen. This is currently only
7130 supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system interface, not an
7131 aliased interface. When specified, all addresses on the same line will only
7132 be accepted if the incoming packets physically come through the designated
7133 interface. It is also possible to bind multiple frontends to the same address
7134 if they are bound to different interfaces. Note that binding to a network
7135 interface requires root privileges. This parameter is only compatible with
7136 TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets.
7137
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02007138level <level>
7139 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
7140 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
7141 sockets. <level> can be one of :
7142 - "user" is the least privileged level ; only non-sensitive stats can be
7143 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
7144 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
7145 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
7146 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (eg: clear max
7147 counters).
7148 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (eg: clear
7149 all counters).
7150
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007151maxconn <maxconn>
7152 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
7153 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
7154 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
7155 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
7156 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
7157 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
7158 eat all memory.
7159
7160mode <mode>
7161 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
7162 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
7163 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
7164 UNIX sockets.
7165
7166mss <maxseg>
7167 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
7168 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
7169 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
7170 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
7171 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
7172 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
7173 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
7174 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
7175 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
7176 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
7177 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
7178
7179name <name>
7180 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
7181 page.
7182
7183nice <nice>
7184 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
7185 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
7186 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
7187 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
7188 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
7189 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
7190 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
7191 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
7192 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
7193 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
7194 one for an RDP socket.
7195
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007196no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007197 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7198 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instanciated from the listener when
7199 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02007200 be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
7201 and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007202
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +02007203no-tls-tickets
7204 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7205 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
7206 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
7207 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage.
7208
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007209no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007210 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02007211 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instanciated from the listener
7212 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
7213 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
7214 and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007215
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007216no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007217 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02007218 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instanciated from the listener
7219 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
7220 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
7221 and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007222
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007223no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007224 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02007225 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instanciated from the listener
7226 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
7227 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
7228 and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007229
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02007230npn <protocols>
7231 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
7232 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
7233 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
7234 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
7235 enabled (check with haproxy -vv).
7236
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007237ssl
7238 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7239 enables SSL deciphering on connections instanciated from this listener. A
7240 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
7241 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
7242 to deciphered contents.
7243
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02007244tfo
7245 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.6. It
7246 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
7247 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
7248 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
7249 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
7250 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
7251 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
7252 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
7253 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
7254
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007255transparent
7256 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
7257 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
7258 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
7259 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
7260 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
7261 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
7262 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
7263 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
7264 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
7265 so check for support with your vendor.
7266
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01007267v4v6
7268 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
7269 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
7270 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
7271 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
7272 sockets, and is overriden by the "v6only" option.
7273
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +01007274v6only
7275 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
7276 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
7277 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01007278 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
7279 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +01007280
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007281uid <uid>
7282 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
7283 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
7284 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
7285 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
7286 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
7287
7288user <user>
7289 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
7290 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
7291 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
7292 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
7293 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
7294
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02007295verify [none|optional|required]
7296 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
7297 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
7298 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
7299 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
7300 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02007301 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
7302 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
7303 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
7304 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02007305
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020073065.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01007307------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007308
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01007309The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
7310which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
7311arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
7312settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
7313after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
7314Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
7315address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007316
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007317 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01007318 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007319
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007320The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007321
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02007322addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007323 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
7324 to send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate an IP
7325 address to specific component able to perform complex tests which are more
7326 suitable to health-checks than the application. This parameter is ignored if
7327 the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007328
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007329 Supported in default-server: No
7330
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007331backup
7332 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
7333 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
7334 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
7335 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
7336 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "allbackups"
7337 option.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007338
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007339 Supported in default-server: No
7340
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02007341ca-file <cafile>
7342 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7343 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
7344 server's certificate.
7345
7346 Supported in default-server: No
7347
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007348check
7349 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +01007350 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
7351 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
7352 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
7353 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
7354 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
7355 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
7356 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
7357 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
7358 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
7359 refer to those options and parameters for more information.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007360
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007361 Supported in default-server: No
7362
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +02007363check-send-proxy
7364 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
7365 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
7366 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
7367 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
7368 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
7369 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
7370 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
7371
7372 Supported in default-server: No
7373
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007374check-ssl
7375 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
7376 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
7377 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
7378 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
7379 inserts an SSL transport layer below the ckecks, so that a simple TCP connect
7380 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
7381 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
7382 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (eg: ciphers).
7383 See the "ssl" option for more information.
7384
7385 Supported in default-server: No
7386
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02007387ciphers <ciphers>
7388 This option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
7389 is negociated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
7390 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers". When SSL is used to communicate with
7391 servers on the local network, it is common to see a weaker set of algorithms
7392 than what is used over the internet. Doing so reduces CPU usage on both the
7393 server and haproxy while still keeping it compatible with deployed software.
7394 Some algorithms such as RC4-SHA1 are reasonably cheap. If no security at all
7395 is needed and just connectivity, using DES can be appropriate.
7396
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007397 Supported in default-server: No
7398
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007399cookie <value>
7400 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
7401 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
7402 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
7403 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
7404 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
7405 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
7406 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
7407
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007408 Supported in default-server: No
7409
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02007410crl-file <crlfile>
7411 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7412 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
7413 to verify server's certificate.
7414
7415 Supported in default-server: No
7416
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +02007417crt <cert>
7418 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
7419 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
7420 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
7421 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
7422 certificate request.
7423
7424 Supported in default-server: No
7425
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +02007426disabled
7427 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
7428 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
7429 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
7430 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
7431 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
7432
7433 Supported in default-server: No
7434
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007435error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01007436 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
7437 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
7438 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007439
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007440 Supported in default-server: Yes
7441
7442 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007443
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007444fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007445 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
7446 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
7447 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
7448
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007449 Supported in default-server: Yes
7450
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007451force-sslv3
7452 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
7453 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
7454 high connection rates. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
7455
7456 Supported in default-server: No
7457
7458force-tlsv10
7459 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
7460 the server. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
7461
7462 Supported in default-server: No
7463
7464force-tlsv11
7465 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
7466 the server. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
7467
7468 Supported in default-server: No
7469
7470force-tlsv12
7471 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
7472 the server. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
7473
7474 Supported in default-server: No
7475
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007476id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02007477 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
7478 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
7479 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007480
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007481 Supported in default-server: No
7482
7483inter <delay>
7484fastinter <delay>
7485downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007486 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
7487 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
7488 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
7489 between checks depending on the server state :
7490
7491 Server state | Interval used
7492 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
7493 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
7494 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
7495 Transitionally UP (going down), |
7496 Transitionally DOWN (going up), | "fastinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
7497 or yet unchecked. |
7498 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
7499 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
7500 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007501
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007502 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
7503 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
7504 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
7505 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
7506 hosted on the same hardware, the health-checks of all servers are started
7507 with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to add some random
7508 noise in the health checks interval using the global "spread-checks"
7509 keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot of backends use the same
7510 servers.
7511
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007512 Supported in default-server: Yes
7513
7514maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007515 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
7516 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
7517 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
7518 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
7519 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
7520 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
7521 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
7522 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
7523
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007524 Supported in default-server: Yes
7525
7526maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007527 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
7528 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
7529 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
7530 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
7531 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
7532 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
7533 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
7534
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007535 Supported in default-server: Yes
7536
7537minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007538 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
7539 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
7540 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
7541 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
7542 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
7543 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007544 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007545 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007546
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007547 Supported in default-server: Yes
7548
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007549no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02007550 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
7551 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007552 using any configuration option. See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02007553
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007554 Supported in default-server: No
7555
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +02007556no-tls-tickets
7557 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7558 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
7559 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
7560 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers.
7561
7562 Supported in default-server: No
7563
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007564no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007565 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007566 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
7567 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007568 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. See
7569 also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007570
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007571 Supported in default-server: No
7572
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007573no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007574 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007575 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
7576 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007577 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. See
7578 also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007579
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007580 Supported in default-server: No
7581
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007582no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007583 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02007584 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
7585 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007586 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. See
7587 also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02007588
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007589 Supported in default-server: No
7590
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +09007591non-stick
7592 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
7593 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
7594 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
7595
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007596 Supported in default-server: No
7597
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007598observe <mode>
7599 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
7600 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
7601 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
7602 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
7603 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
7604 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +01007605 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007606
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007607 Supported in default-server: No
7608
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007609 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
7610
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007611on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007612 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
7613 Currently, four modes are available:
7614 - fastinter: force fastinter
7615 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
7616 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
7617 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
7618 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
7619
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007620 Supported in default-server: Yes
7621
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007622 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
7623
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09007624on-marked-down <action>
7625 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
7626 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07007627 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
7628 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
7629 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
7630 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
7631 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
7632 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
7633 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
7634 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09007635
7636 Actions are disabled by default
7637
7638 Supported in default-server: Yes
7639
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07007640on-marked-up <action>
7641 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
7642 Currently one action is available:
7643 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
7644 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
7645 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
7646 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
7647 with long sessions (eg: LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
7648 than it tries to solve (eg: incomplete transactions), so use this feature
7649 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
7650 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
7651
7652 Actions are disabled by default
7653
7654 Supported in default-server: Yes
7655
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007656port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007657 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
7658 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
7659 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
7660 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
7661 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
7662 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
7663
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007664 Supported in default-server: Yes
7665
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007666redir <prefix>
7667 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
7668 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
7669 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
7670 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
7671 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
7672 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
7673 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
7674 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007675 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007676 requests are still analysed, making this solution completely usable to direct
7677 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
7678 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
7679 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
7680 loop between the client and HAProxy!
7681
7682 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
7683
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007684 Supported in default-server: No
7685
7686rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007687 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
7688 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
7689 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
7690
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007691 Supported in default-server: Yes
7692
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01007693send-proxy
7694 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
7695 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
7696 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
7697 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
7698 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" listener,
7699 the advertised address will be used. Only TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families
7700 are supported. Other families such as Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN
7701 family. Servers using this option can fully be chained to another instance of
7702 haproxy listening with an "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +02007703 used if the server isn't aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent
7704 to the server, the PROXY protocol is automatically used when this option is
7705 set, unless there is an explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an
7706 explicit "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY
7707 protocol. See also the "accept-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01007708
7709 Supported in default-server: No
7710
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007711slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007712 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
7713 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
7714 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
7715 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
7716 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
7717 parameters :
7718
7719 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
7720 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
7721
7722 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
7723 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
7724 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
7725 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
7726
7727 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
7728 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
7729 seen as failed.
7730
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007731 Supported in default-server: Yes
7732
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02007733source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007734source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02007735source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007736 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
7737 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
7738 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
7739 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
7740
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02007741 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
7742 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
7743 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
7744 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
7745 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
7746 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
7747 server.
7748
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007749 Supported in default-server: No
7750
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02007751ssl
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007752 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. At
7753 the moment, server certificates are not checked, so this is prone to man in
7754 the middle attacks. The real intended use is to permit SSL communication
7755 with software which cannot work in other modes over networks that would
7756 otherwise be considered safe enough for clear text communications. When this
7757 option is used, health checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there
7758 is a "port" or an "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a
7759 different location. See the "check-ssl" optino to force SSL health checks.
7760
7761 Supported in default-server: No
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02007762
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007763track [<proxy>/]<server>
7764 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by
7765 tracking another one. Only a server with checks enabled can be tracked
7766 so it is not possible for example to track a server that tracks another
7767 one. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
7768 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
7769
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007770 Supported in default-server: No
7771
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02007772verify [none|required]
7773 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
7774 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. This is the default. In the
7775 other case, The certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from
7776 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
7777 is aborted.
7778
7779 Supported in default-server: No
7780
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007781weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007782 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
7783 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
7784 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +02007785 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
7786 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
7787 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
7788 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
7789 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
7790 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007791
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007792 Supported in default-server: Yes
7793
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007794
77956. HTTP header manipulation
7796---------------------------
7797
7798In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
7799response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
7800request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
7801which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
7802against information leak from the internal network. But there is a limitation
7803to this : since HAProxy's HTTP engine does not support keep-alive, only headers
7804passed during the first request of a TCP session will be seen. All subsequent
7805headers will be considered data only and not analyzed. Furthermore, HAProxy
7806never touches data contents, it stops analysis at the end of headers.
7807
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +02007808There is an exception though. If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response"
7809(status code 1xx), it is able to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny,
7810rewrite or delete a header, but it will refuse to add a header to any such
7811messages as this is not HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers
7812in such responses is to stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007813happen, for instance because another downstream equipment would unconditionally
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +02007814add a header, or if a server name appears there. When such messages are seen,
7815normal processing still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
7816
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007817This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
7818in section 4.2 :
7819
7820 - reqadd <string>
7821 - reqallow <search>
7822 - reqiallow <search>
7823 - reqdel <search>
7824 - reqidel <search>
7825 - reqdeny <search>
7826 - reqideny <search>
7827 - reqpass <search>
7828 - reqipass <search>
7829 - reqrep <search> <replace>
7830 - reqirep <search> <replace>
7831 - reqtarpit <search>
7832 - reqitarpit <search>
7833 - rspadd <string>
7834 - rspdel <search>
7835 - rspidel <search>
7836 - rspdeny <search>
7837 - rspideny <search>
7838 - rsprep <search> <replace>
7839 - rspirep <search> <replace>
7840
7841With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
7842is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
7843parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
7844prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
7845Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
7846
7847 \t for a tab
7848 \r for a carriage return (CR)
7849 \n for a new line (LF)
7850 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
7851 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
7852 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
7853 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
7854 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
7855
7856The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
7857portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
7858above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
7859regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
78609 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
7861is very common to users of the "sed" program.
7862
7863The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
7864after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
7865
7866Notes related to these keywords :
7867---------------------------------
7868 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
7869 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
7870 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
7871
7872 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
7873 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
7874 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
7875
7876 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
7877 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
7878 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
7879 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
7880 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
7881
7882 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
7883 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
7884 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
7885 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
7886 useless headers before adding new ones.
7887
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007888 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007889 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
7890
7891 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
7892 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
7893 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
7894
7895 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
7896 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007897 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007898
7899
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010079007. Using ACLs and pattern extraction
7901------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007902
7903The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
7904content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
7905from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
7906simple :
7907
7908 - define test criteria with sets of values
7909 - perform actions only if a set of tests is valid
7910
7911The actions generally consist in blocking the request, or selecting a backend.
7912
7913In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
7914
7915 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
7916
7917This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
7918Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
7919and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
7920an operator which may be specified before the set of values. The values are
7921of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
7922
7923ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
7924'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
7925which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
7926
7927There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
7928performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
7929
7930The following ACL flags are currently supported :
7931
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02007932 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
7933 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007934 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
7935
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02007936The "-f" flag is special as it loads all of the lines it finds in the file
7937specified in argument and loads all of them before continuing. It is even
7938possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments if the patterns are to be loaded from
Willy Tarreau58215a02010-05-13 22:07:43 +02007939multiple files. Empty lines as well as lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will
7940be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs will be stripped. If it is absolutely
7941needed to insert a valid pattern beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a
7942space so that it is not taken for a comment. Depending on the data type and
7943match method, haproxy may load the lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast
7944lookups. This is true for IPv4 and exact string matching. In this case,
7945duplicates will automatically be removed. Also, note that the "-i" flag applies
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007946to subsequent entries and not to entries loaded from files preceding it. For
Willy Tarreau58215a02010-05-13 22:07:43 +02007947instance :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02007948
7949 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
7950
7951In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
7952the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
7953case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
7954too.
7955
7956Note that right now it is difficult for the ACL parsers to report errors, so if
7957a file is unreadable or unparsable, the most you'll get is a parse error in the
7958ACL. Thus, file-based ACLs should only be produced by reliable processes.
7959
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007960Supported types of values are :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007961
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007962 - integers or integer ranges
7963 - strings
7964 - regular expressions
7965 - IP addresses and networks
7966
7967
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020079687.1. Matching integers
7969----------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007970
7971Matching integers is special in that ranges and operators are permitted. Note
7972that integer matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value
7973expressed with a lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which
7974may be omitted.
7975
7976For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
7977unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
7978representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
7979
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007980As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
7981two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
7982instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
7983ranges and operators.
7984
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007985For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007986operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
7987Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
7988of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007989
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007990Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007991
7992 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
7993 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
7994 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
7995 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
7996 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
7997
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007998For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007999
8000 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
8001
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008002This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
8003
8004 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
8005
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008006
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020080077.2. Matching strings
8008---------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008009
8010String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
8011exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
8012characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
8013string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
8014to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008015before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008016
8017
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020080187.3. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
8019-------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008020
8021Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
8022they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
8023possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
8024passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
8025the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008026the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
8027match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008028
8029
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020080307.4. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008031----------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008032
8033IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
8034netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
8035within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008036host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008037difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
8038at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
8039does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
8040parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008041
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02008042IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
8043Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
8044trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
8045IPv6 patterns.
8046
8047HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
8048following situations :
8049 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
8050 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
8051 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
8052 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
8053 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
8054 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
8055 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
8056 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
8057 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
8058 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
8059
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008060
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020080617.5. Available matching criteria
8062--------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008063
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020080647.5.1. Matching at Layer 4 and below
8065------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008066
8067A first set of criteria applies to information which does not require any
8068analysis of the request or response contents. Those generally include TCP/IP
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008069addresses and ports, as well as internal values independent on the stream.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008070
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008071always_false
8072 This one never matches. All values and flags are ignored. It may be used as
8073 a temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
8074
8075always_true
8076 This one always matches. All values and flags are ignored. It may be used as
8077 a temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
8078
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008079avg_queue <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008080avg_queue(<backend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008081 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
8082 divided by the number of active servers. This is very similar to "queue"
8083 except that the size of the farm is considered, in order to give a more
8084 accurate measurement of the time it may take for a new connection to be
8085 processed. The main usage is to return a sorry page to new users when it
8086 becomes certain they will get a degraded service. Note that in the event
8087 there would not be any active server anymore, we would consider twice the
8088 number of queued connections as the measured value. This is a fair estimate,
8089 as we expect one server to get back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send
8090 new traffic to another backend if in better shape. See also the "queue",
8091 "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +01008092
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02008093be_conn <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008094be_conn(<backend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02008095 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
8096 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
8097 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
8098 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
8099 See also the "fe_conn", "queue" and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008100
Hervé COMMOWICK35ed8012010-12-15 14:04:51 +01008101be_id <integer>
8102 Applies to the backend's id. Can be used in frontends to check from which
8103 backend it was called.
8104
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008105be_sess_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008106be_sess_rate(<backend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008107 Returns true when the sessions creation rate on the backend matches the
8108 specified values or ranges, in number of new sessions per second. This is
8109 used to switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one
8110 reaches too high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent
8111 sucking of an online dictionary).
8112
8113 Example :
8114 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
8115 backend dynamic
8116 mode http
8117 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
8118 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008119
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -05008120srv_sess_rate(<backend>/<server>) <integer>
8121 Returns true when the sessions creation rate on the server matches the
8122 specified values or ranges, in number of new sessions per second. This is
8123 used to switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one
8124 reaches too high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent
8125 latent requests from overloading servers).
8126
8127 Example :
8128 # Redirect to a separate back
8129 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
8130 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
8131 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
8132
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08008133connslots <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008134connslots(<backend>) <integer>
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08008135 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008136 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08008137 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
8138
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008139 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
8140 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08008141
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02008142 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008143 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
8144 multiple backends (perhaps using acls to do name-based load balancing) and
8145 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
8146 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
8147 actually *down*, this acl is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02008148 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08008149
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008150 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
8151 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
8152 then this acl clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
8153 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08008154
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008155dst <ip_address>
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02008156 Applies to the local IPv4 or IPv6 address the client connected to. It can be
8157 used to switch to a different backend for some alternative addresses.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02008158
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008159dst_conn <integer>
8160 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the same socket
8161 including the one being evaluated. It can be used to either return a sorry
8162 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
8163 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
8164 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
8165 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" criteria.
8166
8167dst_port <integer>
8168 Applies to the local port the client connected to. It can be used to switch
8169 to a different backend for some alternative ports.
8170
8171fe_conn <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008172fe_conn(<frontend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008173 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
8174 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
8175 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
8176 frontend. It can be used to either return a sorry page before hard-blocking,
8177 or to use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is
8178 considered saturated. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn" and "fe_sess_rate"
8179 criteria.
8180
8181fe_id <integer>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01008182 Applies to the frontend's id. Can be used in backends to check from which
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008183 frontend it was called.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02008184
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01008185fe_sess_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008186fe_sess_rate(<frontend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01008187 Returns true when the session creation rate on the current or the named
8188 frontend matches the specified values or ranges, expressed in new sessions
8189 per second. This is used to limit the connection rate to acceptable ranges in
8190 order to prevent abuse of service at the earliest moment. This can be
8191 combined with layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for
8192 the rate to go down below the limit.
8193
8194 Example :
8195 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
8196 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
8197 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
8198 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
8199 frontend mail
8200 bind :25
8201 mode tcp
8202 maxconn 100
8203 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
8204 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
8205 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
8206 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008207
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008208nbsrv <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008209nbsrv(<backend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008210 Returns true when the number of usable servers of either the current backend
8211 or the named backend matches the values or ranges specified. This is used to
8212 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
8213 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
8214 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01008215
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008216queue <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008217queue(<backend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008218 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
8219 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
8220 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
8221 one. This can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level,
8222 generally indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers.
8223 One possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones.
8224 See also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
8225
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01008226sc1_bytes_in_rate <integer>
8227sc2_bytes_in_rate <integer>
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008228 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
8229 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
8230 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
8231
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01008232sc1_bytes_out_rate <integer>
8233sc2_bytes_out_rate <integer>
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008234 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
8235 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
8236 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
8237
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01008238sc1_clr_gpc0 <integer>
8239sc2_clr_gpc0 <integer>
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02008240 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
8241 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01008242 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
8243 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
8244 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02008245
8246 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
8247 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
8248 acl abuse sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
8249 acl kill sc1_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01008250 acl save sc1_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02008251 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
8252 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
8253
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01008254sc1_conn_cnt <integer>
8255sc2_conn_cnt <integer>
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008256 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections from currently tracked
8257 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
8258
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01008259sc1_conn_cur <integer>
8260sc2_conn_cur <integer>
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008261 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
8262 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
8263 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
8264
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01008265sc1_conn_rate <integer>
8266sc2_conn_rate <integer>
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008267 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
8268 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
8269 See also src_conn_rate.
8270
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01008271sc1_get_gpc0 <integer>
8272sc2_get_gpc0 <integer>
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008273 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
8274 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
8275
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01008276sc1_http_err_cnt <integer>
8277sc2_http_err_cnt <integer>
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008278 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
8279 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
8280 See also src_http_err_cnt.
8281
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01008282sc1_http_err_rate <integer>
8283sc2_http_err_rate <integer>
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008284 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
8285 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
8286 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
8287 src_http_err_rate.
8288
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01008289sc1_http_req_cnt <integer>
8290sc2_http_req_cnt <integer>
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008291 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
8292 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
8293 src_http_req_cnt.
8294
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01008295sc1_http_req_rate <integer>
8296sc2_http_req_rate <integer>
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008297 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
8298 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
8299 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
8300 src_http_req_rate.
8301
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01008302sc1_inc_gpc0 <integer>
8303sc2_inc_gpc0 <integer>
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008304 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01008305 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
8306 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
8307 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
8308 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008309
8310 acl abuse sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01008311 acl kill sc1_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008312 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
8313
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01008314sc1_kbytes_in <integer>
8315sc2_kbytes_in <integer>
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008316 Returns the amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
8317 counters, measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. The
8318 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
8319 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
8320
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01008321sc1_kbytes_out <integer>
8322sc2_kbytes_out <integer>
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008323 Returns the amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
8324 counters, measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. The
8325 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
8326 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
8327
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01008328sc1_sess_cnt <integer>
8329sc2_sess_cnt <integer>
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008330 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections that were transformed
8331 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
8332 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
8333 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008334 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008335 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
8336
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01008337sc1_sess_rate <integer>
8338sc2_sess_rate <integer>
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008339 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
8340 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
8341 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
8342 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
8343 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008344 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008345
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01008346sc1_trackers <integer>
8347sc2_trackers <integer>
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +01008348 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
8349 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
8350 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc1_conn_cur in
8351 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
8352 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
8353 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking.
8354
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008355so_id <integer>
8356 Applies to the socket's id. Useful in frontends with many bind keywords.
8357
8358src <ip_address>
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02008359 Applies to the client's IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is usually used to limit
8360 access to certain resources such as statistics. Note that it is the TCP-level
8361 source address which is used, and not the address of a client behind a proxy.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008362
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008363src_bytes_in_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008364src_bytes_in_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008365 Returns the average bytes rate from the connection's source IPv4 address in
8366 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
8367 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008368 not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008369
8370src_bytes_out_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008371src_bytes_out_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008372 Returns the average bytes rate to the connection's source IPv4 address in the
8373 current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
8374 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008375 not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008376
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02008377src_clr_gpc0 <integer>
8378src_clr_gpc0(<table>) <integer>
8379 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the connection's
8380 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
8381 stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not found, an
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01008382 entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a second ACL in
8383 an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02008384
8385 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
8386 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
8387 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
8388 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01008389 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02008390 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
8391 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
8392
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008393src_conn_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008394src_conn_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008395 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
8396 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
8397 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008398 See also sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008399
8400src_conn_cur <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008401src_conn_cur(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008402 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
8403 current connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table
8404 or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008405 returned. See also sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008406
8407src_conn_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008408src_conn_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008409 Returns the average connection rate from the connection's source IPv4 address
8410 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
8411 in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If the
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008412 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008413
8414src_get_gpc0 <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008415src_get_gpc0(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008416 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
8417 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
8418 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008419 See also sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008420
8421src_http_err_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008422src_http_err_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008423 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the current connection's
8424 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
8425 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008426 If the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008427
8428src_http_err_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008429src_http_err_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008430 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the current connection's source
8431 IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
8432 table, measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table.
8433 This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008434 is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008435
8436src_http_req_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008437src_http_req_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008438 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the current connection's
8439 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
8440 stick-table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008441 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008442
8443src_http_req_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008444src_http_req_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008445 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the current connection's
8446 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
8447 stick-table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
8448 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008449 not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008450
8451src_inc_gpc0 <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008452src_inc_gpc0(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008453 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the connection's
8454 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01008455 stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not found, an entry
8456 is created and 1 is returned. This is typically used as a second ACL in an
8457 expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008458
8459 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01008460 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008461 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008462
8463src_kbytes_in <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008464src_kbytes_in(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008465 Returns the amount of data received from the connection's source IPv4 address
8466 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
8467 in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is not
8468 found, zero is returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008469 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008470
8471src_kbytes_out <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008472src_kbytes_out(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008473 Returns the amount of data sent to the connection's source IPv4 address in
8474 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
8475 in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is not
8476 found, zero is returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008477 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02008478
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008479src_port <integer>
8480 Applies to the client's TCP source port. This has a very limited usage.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01008481
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008482src_sess_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008483src_sess_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008484 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
8485 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
8486 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
8487 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008488 is returned. See also sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008489
8490src_sess_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008491src_sess_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008492 Returns the average session rate from the connection's source IPv4 address in
8493 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
8494 amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A session is a
8495 connection that got past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008496 found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008497
8498src_updt_conn_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008499src_updt_conn_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02008500 Creates or updates the entry associated to the source IPv4 address in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008501 current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table. This table
8502 must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise the match
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02008503 will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the expiration
8504 timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match can't return
8505 zero. This is used to reject service abusers based on their source address.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008506 Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-counters" instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02008507
8508 Example :
8509 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
8510 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
8511 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
8512 listen ssh
8513 bind :22
8514 mode tcp
8515 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008516 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02008517 tcp-request content reject if { src_update_count gt 3 }
8518 server local 127.0.0.1:22
8519
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008520srv_conn(<backend>/<server>) <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +02008521 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the server,
8522 possibly including the connection being evaluated.
8523 It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is full.
8524 See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn" and "queue" criteria.
8525
Hervé COMMOWICK35ed8012010-12-15 14:04:51 +01008526srv_id <integer>
8527 Applies to the server's id. Can be used in frontends or backends.
8528
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +02008529srv_is_up(<server>)
8530srv_is_up(<backend>/<server>)
8531 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
8532 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
8533 looked up in the current backend. The function takes no arguments since it
8534 is used as a boolean. It is mainly used to take action based on an external
8535 status reported via a health check (eg: a geographical site's availability).
8536 Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in using dummy servers
8537 as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from the CLI, so that
8538 rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
8539
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +02008540table_avl <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008541table_avl(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +02008542 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
8543 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
8544
8545table_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008546table_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +02008547 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
8548 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
8549 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
8550
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008551
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020085527.5.2. Matching contents at Layer 4 (also called Layer 6)
8553---------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008554
8555A second set of criteria depends on data found in buffers, but which can change
8556during analysis. This requires that some data has been buffered, for instance
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008557through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request content"
8558keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008559
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01008560rep_ssl_hello_type <integer>
8561 Returns true when data in the response buffer looks like a complete SSL (v3
8562 or superior) hello message and handshake type is equal to <integer>.
8563 This test was designed to be used with TCP response content inspection: a
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008564 SSL session ID may be fetched. Note that this only applies to raw contents
8565 found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data
8566 layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01008567
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008568req_len <integer>
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02008569 Returns true when the length of the data in the request buffer matches the
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008570 specified range. It is important to understand that this test does not
8571 return false as long as the buffer is changing. This means that a check with
8572 equality to zero will almost always immediately match at the beginning of the
8573 session, while a test for more data will wait for that data to come in and
8574 return false only when haproxy is certain that no more data will come in.
8575 This test was designed to be used with TCP request content inspection.
8576
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +02008577req_proto_http
8578 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
8579 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008580 is used so there should be no surprises. This test can be used for instance
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +02008581 to direct HTTP traffic to a given port and HTTPS traffic to another one
8582 using TCP request content inspection rules.
8583
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02008584req_rdp_cookie <string>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008585req_rdp_cookie(<name>) <string>
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02008586 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like the RDP protocol, and
8587 a cookie is present and equal to <string>. By default, any cookie name is
8588 checked, but a specific cookie name can be specified in parenthesis. The
8589 parser only checks for the first cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol
8590 specification. The cookie name is case insensitive. This ACL can be useful
8591 with the "MSTS" cookie, as it can contain the user name of the client
8592 connecting to the server if properly configured on the client. This can be
8593 used to restrict access to certain servers to certain users.
8594
8595req_rdp_cookie_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008596req_rdp_cookie_cnt(<name>) <integer>
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02008597 Returns true when the data in the request buffer look like the RDP protocol
8598 and the number of RDP cookies matches the specified range (typically zero or
8599 one). Optionally a specific cookie name can be checked. This is a simple way
8600 of detecting the RDP protocol, as clients generally send the MSTS or MSTSHASH
8601 cookies.
8602
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01008603req_ssl_hello_type <integer>
8604 Returns true when data in the request buffer looks like a complete SSL (v3
8605 or superior) hello message and handshake type is equal to <integer>.
8606 This test was designed to be used with TCP request content inspection: an
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008607 SSL session ID may be fetched. Note that this only applies to raw contents
8608 found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data
8609 layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01008610
8611req_ssl_sni <string>
8612 Returns true when data in the request buffer looks like a complete SSL (v3
8613 or superior) client hello message with a Server Name Indication TLS extension
8614 (SNI) matching <string>. SNI normally contains the name of the host the
8615 client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is useful for allowing
8616 or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used by the client. This
8617 test was designed to be used with TCP request content inspection. If content
8618 switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait for a complete client
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008619 hello (type 1), like in the example below. Note that this only applies to raw
8620 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02008621 SSL transport layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008622 option. See also "ssl_sni" below.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01008623
8624 Examples :
8625 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
8626 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
8627 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
8628 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
8629 default_backend bk_sorry_page
8630
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008631req_ssl_ver <decimal>
8632 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like SSL, with a protocol
8633 version matching the specified range. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
8634 messages are supported. The test tries to be strict enough to avoid being
8635 easily fooled. In particular, it waits for as many bytes as announced in the
8636 message header if this header looks valid (bound to the buffer size). Note
8637 that TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. This test was designed to be used
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008638 with TCP request content inspection. Note that this only applies to raw
8639 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02008640 SSL transport layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008641 option.
8642
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02008643ssl_c_ca_err <integer>
8644 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8645 layer, and the ID of the first error detected during verification of the
8646 client certificate at depth > 0 matches the specified value (check man verify
8647 for possible values). Note that error zero means no error was encountered
8648 during this verification process.
8649
8650ssl_c_ca_err_depth <integer>
8651 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8652 layer, and the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
8653 verification of the client certificate matches the specified value. When no
8654 error is found, depth 0 is returned.
8655
8656ssl_c_err <integer>
8657 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8658 layer, and the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth==0
8659 matches the specified value (check man verify for possible values). Note that
8660 error zero means no error was encountered during this verification process.
8661
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02008662ssl_c_i_dn <string>
8663ssl_c_i_dn(entry[,occ]) <string>
8664 If no entry specified, returns true when the incoming connection was made
8665 over an SSL/TLS transport layer, and the full distinguished name of the
8666 issuer of the certificate presented by the client matches the specified
8667 string. Otherwise returns true if the value of the first given entry from
8668 the beginning of the DN matches the specified string. If a positive/negative
8669 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
8670 true if the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the
8671 DN matches the specified string.
8672
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +02008673ssl_c_key_alg <string>
8674 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8675 layer, and the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the
8676 certificate presented by the client matches the string.
8677
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +02008678ssl_c_notafter <string>
8679 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8680 layer, and the end date of the certificate presented by the client matches
8681 the string formatted as YYMMDDhhmmss[Z].
8682
8683ssl_c_notbefore <string>
8684 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8685 layer, and the start date of the certificate presented by the client matches
8686 the string formatted as YYMMDDhhmmss[Z].
8687
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02008688ssl_c_s_dn <string>
8689ssl_c_s_dn(entry[,occ]) <string>
8690 If no entry specified, returns true when the incoming connection was made
8691 over an SSL/TLS transport layer, and the full distinguished name of the
8692 subject of the certificate presented by the client matches the specified
8693 string. Otherwise returns true if the value of the first given entry from
8694 the beginning of the DN matches the specified string. If a positive/negative
8695 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
8696 true if the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the
8697 DN matches the specified string.
8698
Willy Tarreau8d598402012-10-22 17:58:39 +02008699ssl_c_serial <hexa>
8700 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8701 layer, and the serial of the certificate presented by the client matches
8702 the value written in hexa.
8703
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +02008704ssl_c_sig_alg <string>
8705 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8706 layer, and the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented
8707 by the client matches the string.
8708
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +01008709ssl_c_used
8710 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
8711 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
8712
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02008713ssl_c_verify <integer>
8714 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8715 layer, and the verify result matches the specified value (check man verify
8716 for possible values). Zero indicates no error was detected.
8717
Emeric Bruna7359fd2012-10-17 15:03:11 +02008718ssl_c_version <integer>
8719 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8720 layer, and the version of the certificate presented by the client matches
8721 the value.
8722
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02008723ssl_f_i_dn <string>
8724ssl_f_i_dn(entry[,occ]) <string>
8725 If no entry specified, returns true when the incoming connection was made
8726 over an SSL/TLS transport layer, and the full distinguished name of the
8727 issuer of the certificate presented by the frontend matches the specified
8728 string. Otherwise returns true if the value of the first given entry from
8729 the beginning of the DN matches the specified string. If a positive/negative
8730 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
8731 true if the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the
8732 DN matches the specified string.
8733
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +02008734ssl_c_key_alg <string>
8735 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8736 layer, and the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the
8737 certificate presented by the frontend matches the string.
8738
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +02008739ssl_f_notafter <string>
8740 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8741 layer, and the end date of the certificate presented by the frontend matches
8742 the string formatted as YYMMDDhhmmss[Z].
8743
8744ssl_f_notbefore <string>
8745 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8746 layer, and the start date of the certificate presented by the frontend matches
8747 the string formatted as YYMMDDhhmmss[Z].
8748
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02008749ssl_f_s_dn <string>
8750ssl_f_s_dn(entry[,occ]) <string>
8751 If no entry specified, returns true when the incoming connection was made
8752 over an SSL/TLS transport layer, and the full distinguished name of the
8753 subject of the certificate presented by the frontend matches the specified
8754 string. Otherwise returns true if the value of the first given entry from
8755 the beginning of the DN matches the specified string. If a positive/negative
8756 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
8757 true if the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the
8758 DN matches the specified string.
8759
Willy Tarreau8d598402012-10-22 17:58:39 +02008760ssl_f_serial <hexa>
8761 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8762 layer, and the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend matches
8763 the value written in hexa.
8764
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +02008765ssl_f_sig_alg <string>
8766 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8767 layer, and the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented
8768 by the frontend matches the string.
8769
Emeric Bruna7359fd2012-10-17 15:03:11 +02008770ssl_f_version <integer>
8771 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8772 layer, and the version of the certificate presented by the frontend matches
8773 the value.
8774
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02008775ssl_fc
8776 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
8777 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
8778 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
8779
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +02008780ssl_fc_alg_keysize <integer>
8781 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8782 layer and the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits matches the value.
8783
8784ssl_fc_cipher <string>
8785 returns true when the incoming connection was made over an ssl/tls transport
8786 layer and the name of the used cipher matches the string.
8787
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02008788ssl_fc_has_crt
8789 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
8790 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +01008791 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
8792 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
8793 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
8794 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02008795
8796ssl_fc_has_sni
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008797 This is used to check for presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02008798 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
8799 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
8800 that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
8801 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008802
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02008803ssl_fc_npn <string>
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +02008804 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8805 layer which deciphered it and found a Next Protocol Negociation TLS extension
8806 sent by the client, matching the specified string. This requires that the SSL
8807 library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02008808 Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on
8809 the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to
8810 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be requested.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +02008811
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +02008812ssl_fc_protocol <string>
8813 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8814 layer and the name of the used protocol matches the string.
8815
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02008816ssl_fc_sni <string>
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02008817 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8818 layer which deciphered it and found a Server Name Indication TLS extension
8819 sent by the client, matching the specified string. In HTTPS, the SNI field
8820 (when present) is equal to the requested host name. This match is different
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +02008821 from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the connection being
8822 deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly forwarded.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02008823 See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_req" below. This requires that the
8824 SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
8825 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008826
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02008827ssl_fc_sni_end <string>
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02008828 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8829 layer which deciphered it and found a Server Name Indication TLS extension
8830 sent by the client, ending like the specified string. In HTTPS, the SNI field
8831 (when present) is equal to the requested host name. This match is different
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +02008832 from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the connection being
8833 deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly forwarded. This
8834 requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
8835 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008836
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02008837ssl_fc_sni_reg <regex>
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02008838 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8839 layer which deciphered it and found a Server Name Indication TLS extension
8840 sent by the client, matching the specified regex. In HTTPS, the SNI field
8841 (when present) is equal to the requested host name. This match is different
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +02008842 from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the connection being
8843 deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly forwarded. This
8844 requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
8845 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008846
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +02008847ssl_fc_use_keysize <integer>
8848 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8849 layer and the symmetric cipher key size used in bits matches the value.
8850
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +02008851wait_end
8852 Waits for the end of the analysis period to return true. This may be used in
8853 conjunction with content analysis to avoid returning a wrong verdict early.
8854 It may also be used to delay some actions, such as a delayed reject for some
8855 special addresses. Since it either stops the rules evaluation or immediately
8856 returns true, it is recommended to use this acl as the last one in a rule.
8857 Please note that the default ACL "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior
8858 declaration. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
8859 inspection.
8860
8861 Examples :
8862 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
8863 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
8864 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
8865
8866 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
8867 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
8868 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
8869 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
8870 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
8871 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
8872 tcp-request content reject
8873
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008874
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020088757.5.3. Matching at Layer 7
8876--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008877
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008878A third set of criteria applies to information which can be found at the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008879application layer (layer 7). Those require that a full HTTP request has been
8880read, and are only evaluated then. They may require slightly more CPU resources
8881than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and response are indexed.
8882
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +02008883base <string>
8884 Returns true when the concatenation of the first Host header and the path
8885 part of the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the
8886 question mark, equals one of the strings. It may be used to match known
8887 files in virtual hosting environments, such as "www.example.com/favicon.ico".
8888 See also "path" and "uri".
8889
8890base_beg <string>
8891 Returns true when the base (see above) begins with one of the strings. This
8892 can be used to send certain directory names to alternative backends. See also
8893 "path_beg".
8894
8895base_dir <string>
8896 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with
8897 slashes in the base (see above). Probably of little use, see "url_dir" and
8898 "path_dir" instead.
8899
8900base_dom <string>
8901 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with dots
8902 in the base (see above). Probably of little use, see "path_dom" and "url_dom"
8903 instead.
8904
8905base_end <string>
8906 Returns true when the base (see above) ends with one of the strings. This may
8907 be used to control file name extension, though "path_end" is cheaper.
8908
8909base_len <integer>
8910 Returns true when the base (see above) length matches the values or ranges
8911 specified. This may be used to detect abusive requests for instance.
8912
8913base_reg <regex>
8914 Returns true when the base (see above) matches one of the regular
8915 expressions. It can be used any time, but it is important to remember that
8916 regex matching is slower than other methods. See also "path_reg", "url_reg"
8917 and all "base_" criteria.
8918
8919base_sub <string>
8920 Returns true when the base (see above) contains one of the strings. It can be
8921 used to detect particular patterns in paths, such as "../" for example. See
8922 also "base_dir".
8923
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +02008924cook(<name>) <string>
8925 All "cook*" matching criteria inspect all "Cookie" headers to find a cookie
8926 with the name between parenthesis. If multiple occurrences of the cookie are
8927 found in the request, they will all be evaluated. Spaces around the name and
8928 the value are ignored as requested by the Cookie specification (RFC6265). The
8929 cookie name is case-sensitive. Use the scook() variant for response cookies
8930 sent by the server.
8931
8932 The "cook" criteria returns true if any of the request cookies <name> match
8933 any of the strings. This can be used to check exact for values. For instance,
8934 checking that the "profile" cookie is set to either "silver" or "gold" :
8935
8936 cook(profile) silver gold
8937
8938cook_beg(<name>) <string>
8939 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> begins with one of the
8940 strings. See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the
8941 scook_beg() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8942
8943cook_cnt(<name>) <integer>
8944 Returns true when the number of occurrences of the specified cookie matches
8945 the values or ranges specified. This is used to detect presence, absence or
8946 abuse of a specific cookie. See "cook" for more information on header
8947 matching. Use the scook_cnt() variant for response cookies sent by the
8948 server.
8949
8950cook_dir(<name>) <string>
8951 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> contains one of the strings
8952 either isolated or delimited by slashes. This is used to perform filename or
8953 directory name matching, though it generally is of limited use with cookies.
8954 See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the scook_dir()
8955 variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8956
8957cook_dom(<name>) <string>
8958 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> contains one of the strings
8959 either isolated or delimited by dots. This is used to perform domain name
8960 matching. See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the
8961 scook_dom() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8962
8963cook_end(<name>) <string>
8964 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> ends with one of the
8965 strings. See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the
8966 scook_end() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8967
8968cook_len(<name>) <integer>
8969 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> has a length which matches
8970 the values or ranges specified. This may be used to detect empty or too large
8971 cookie values. Note that an absent cookie does not match a zero-length test.
8972 See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the scook_len()
8973 variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8974
8975cook_reg(<name>) <regex>
8976 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> matches any of the regular
8977 expressions. It can be used at any time, but it is important to remember that
8978 regex matching is slower than other methods. See also other "cook_" criteria,
8979 as well as "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the
8980 scook_reg() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8981
8982cook_sub(<name>) <string>
8983 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> contains at least one of
8984 the strings. See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the
8985 scook_sub() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8986
Willy Tarreau51539362012-05-08 12:46:28 +02008987cook_val(<name>) <integer>
8988 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> starts with a number which
8989 matches the values or ranges specified. This may be used to select a server
8990 based on application-specific cookies. Note that an absent cookie does not
8991 match any value. See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the
8992 scook_val() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8993
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008994hdr <string>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008995hdr(<header>[,<occ>]) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008996 Note: all the "hdr*" matching criteria either apply to all headers, or to a
8997 particular header whose name is passed between parenthesis and without any
8998 space. The header name is not case-sensitive. The header matching complies
8999 with RFC2616, and treats as separate headers all values delimited by commas.
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02009000 If an occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, only
9001 this occurrence will be considered. Positive values indicate a position from
9002 the first occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
9003 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. Use the shdr()
9004 variant for response headers sent by the server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009005
9006 The "hdr" criteria returns true if any of the headers matching the criteria
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +02009007 match any of the strings. This can be used to check for exact values. For
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009008 instance, checking that "connection: close" is set :
9009
9010 hdr(Connection) -i close
9011
9012hdr_beg <string>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02009013hdr_beg(<header>[,<occ>]) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009014 Returns true when one of the headers begins with one of the strings. See
9015 "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_beg() variant for
9016 response headers sent by the server.
9017
9018hdr_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02009019hdr_cnt(<header>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009020 Returns true when the number of occurrence of the specified header matches
9021 the values or ranges specified. It is important to remember that one header
9022 line may count as several headers if it has several values. This is used to
9023 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
9024 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
9025 of certain headers. See "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use
9026 the shdr_cnt() variant for response headers sent by the server.
9027
9028hdr_dir <string>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02009029hdr_dir(<header>[,<occ>]) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009030 Returns true when one of the headers contains one of the strings either
9031 isolated or delimited by slashes. This is used to perform filename or
9032 directory name matching, and may be used with Referer. See "hdr" for more
9033 information on header matching. Use the shdr_dir() variant for response
9034 headers sent by the server.
9035
9036hdr_dom <string>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02009037hdr_dom(<header>[,<occ>]) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009038 Returns true when one of the headers contains one of the strings either
9039 isolated or delimited by dots. This is used to perform domain name matching,
9040 and may be used with the Host header. See "hdr" for more information on
9041 header matching. Use the shdr_dom() variant for response headers sent by the
9042 server.
9043
9044hdr_end <string>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02009045hdr_end(<header>[,<occ>]) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009046 Returns true when one of the headers ends with one of the strings. See "hdr"
9047 for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_end() variant for
9048 response headers sent by the server.
9049
9050hdr_ip <ip_address>
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02009051hdr_ip(<header>[,<occ>]) <address>
9052 Returns true when one of the headers' values contains an IPv4 or IPv6 address
9053 matching <address>. This is mainly used with headers such as X-Forwarded-For
9054 or X-Client-IP. See "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009055 shdr_ip() variant for response headers sent by the server.
9056
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +02009057hdr_len <integer>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02009058hdr_len(<header>[,<occ>]) <integer>
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +02009059 Returns true when at least one of the headers has a length which matches the
9060 values or ranges specified. This may be used to detect empty or too large
9061 headers. See "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the
9062 shdr_len() variant for response headers sent by the server.
9063
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009064hdr_reg <regex>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02009065hdr_reg(<header>[,<occ>]) <regex>
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +02009066 Returns true it one of the headers matches one of the regular expressions. It
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009067 can be used at any time, but it is important to remember that regex matching
9068 is slower than other methods. See also other "hdr_" criteria, as well as
9069 "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_reg() variant for
9070 response headers sent by the server.
9071
9072hdr_sub <string>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02009073hdr_sub(<header>[,<occ>]) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009074 Returns true when one of the headers contains one of the strings. See "hdr"
9075 for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_sub() variant for
9076 response headers sent by the server.
9077
9078hdr_val <integer>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02009079hdr_val(<header>[,<occ>]) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009080 Returns true when one of the headers starts with a number which matches the
9081 values or ranges specified. This may be used to limit content-length to
9082 acceptable values for example. See "hdr" for more information on header
9083 matching. Use the shdr_val() variant for response headers sent by the server.
9084
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02009085http_auth(<userlist>)
9086http_auth_group(<userlist>) <group> [<group>]*
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009087 Returns true when authentication data received from the client matches
9088 username & password stored on the userlist. It is also possible to
9089 use http_auth_group to check if the user is assigned to at least one
9090 of specified groups.
9091
9092 Currently only http basic auth is supported.
9093
Willy Tarreau85c27da2011-09-16 07:53:52 +02009094http_first_req
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +02009095 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
9096 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
9097 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or even to perform
9098 some specific ACL checks only on the first request.
9099
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009100method <string>
9101 Applies to the method in the HTTP request, eg: "GET". Some predefined ACL
9102 already check for most common methods.
9103
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009104path <string>
9105 Returns true when the path part of the request, which starts at the first
9106 slash and ends before the question mark, equals one of the strings. It may be
9107 used to match known files, such as /favicon.ico.
9108
9109path_beg <string>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009110 Returns true when the path begins with one of the strings. This can be used
9111 to send certain directory names to alternative backends.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009112
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009113path_dir <string>
9114 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with
9115 slashes in the path. This is used to perform filename or directory name
9116 matching without the risk of wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also
9117 "url_dir" and "path_sub".
9118
9119path_dom <string>
9120 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with dots
9121 in the path. This may be used to perform domain name matching in proxy
9122 requests. See also "path_sub" and "url_dom".
9123
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009124path_end <string>
9125 Returns true when the path ends with one of the strings. This may be used to
9126 control file name extension.
9127
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +02009128path_len <integer>
9129 Returns true when the path length matches the values or ranges specified.
9130 This may be used to detect abusive requests for instance.
9131
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009132path_reg <regex>
9133 Returns true when the path matches one of the regular expressions. It can be
9134 used any time, but it is important to remember that regex matching is slower
9135 than other methods. See also "url_reg" and all "path_" criteria.
9136
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009137path_sub <string>
9138 Returns true when the path contains one of the strings. It can be used to
9139 detect particular patterns in paths, such as "../" for example. See also
9140 "path_dir".
9141
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +02009142payload(<offset>,<length>) <string>
9143 Returns true if the block of <length> bytes, starting at byte <offset> in the
9144 request or response buffer (depending on the rule) exactly matches one of the
9145 strings.
9146
9147payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>])
9148 Returns true if the block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
9149 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
9150 the request or response buffer (depending on the rule) exactly matches one of
9151 the strings. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
9152 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
9153
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009154req_ver <string>
9155 Applies to the version string in the HTTP request, eg: "1.0". Some predefined
9156 ACL already check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
9157
9158status <integer>
9159 Applies to the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, eg: "302". It can be
9160 used to act on responses depending on status ranges, for instance, remove
9161 any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
9162
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009163url <string>
9164 Applies to the whole URL passed in the request. The only real use is to match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +02009165 "*", for which there already is a predefined ACL. See also "base".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009166
9167url_beg <string>
9168 Returns true when the URL begins with one of the strings. This can be used to
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +02009169 check whether a URL begins with a slash or with a protocol scheme. See also
9170 "base_beg".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009171
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009172url_dir <string>
9173 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with
9174 slashes in the URL. This is used to perform filename or directory name
9175 matching without the risk of wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also
9176 "path_dir" and "url_sub".
9177
9178url_dom <string>
9179 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with dots
9180 in the URL. This is used to perform domain name matching without the risk of
9181 wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also "url_sub".
9182
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009183url_end <string>
9184 Returns true when the URL ends with one of the strings. It has very limited
9185 use. "path_end" should be used instead for filename matching.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009186
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02009187url_ip <address>
9188 Applies to the IPv4 or IPv6 address specified in the absolute URI in an HTTP
9189 request. It can be used to prevent access to certain resources such as local
9190 network. It is useful with option "http_proxy".
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +01009191
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +02009192url_len <integer>
9193 Returns true when the url length matches the values or ranges specified. This
9194 may be used to detect abusive requests for instance.
9195
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +01009196url_port <integer>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009197 Applies to the port specified in the absolute URI in an HTTP request. It can
9198 be used to prevent access to certain resources. It is useful with option
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01009199 "http_proxy". Note that if the port is not specified in the request, port 80
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009200 is assumed.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +01009201
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009202url_reg <regex>
9203 Returns true when the URL matches one of the regular expressions. It can be
9204 used any time, but it is important to remember that regex matching is slower
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +02009205 than other methods. See also "base_reg", "path_reg" and all "url_" criteria.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01009206
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009207url_sub <string>
9208 Returns true when the URL contains one of the strings. It can be used to
9209 detect particular patterns in query strings for example. See also "path_sub".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01009210
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +02009211urlp(<name>) <string>
9212 Note: all "urlp*" matching criteria apply to the first occurrence of the
9213 parameter <name> in the query string. The parameter name is case-sensitive.
9214
9215 The "urlp" matching criteria returns true if the designated URL parameter
9216 matches any of the strings. This can be used to check for exact values.
9217
9218urlp_beg(<name>) <string>
9219 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" begins with one of the strings.
9220 This can be used to check whether a URL begins with a slash or with a
9221 protocol scheme.
9222
9223urlp_dir(<name>) <string>
9224 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" contains one of the strings
9225 either isolated or delimited with slashes. This is used to perform filename
9226 or directory name matching in a specific URL parameter without the risk of
9227 wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also "path_dir" and "urlp_sub".
9228
9229urlp_dom(<name>) <string>
9230 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with dots
9231 in the URL parameter "<name>". This is used to perform domain name matching
9232 in a specific URL parameter without the risk of wrong match due to colliding
9233 prefixes. See also "urlp_sub".
9234
9235urlp_end(<name>) <string>
9236 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" ends with one of the strings.
9237
9238urlp_ip(<name>) <ip_address>
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02009239 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" contains an IPv4 or IPv6 address
9240 which matches one of the specified addresses.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +02009241
9242urlp_len(<name>) <integer>
9243 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" has a length matching the values
9244 or ranges specified. This is used to detect abusive requests for instance.
9245
9246urlp_reg(<name>) <regex>
9247 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" matches one of the regular
9248 expressions. It can be used any time, but it is important to remember that
9249 regex matching is slower than other methods. See also "path_reg" and all
9250 "urlp_" criteria.
9251
9252urlp_sub(<name>) <string>
9253 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" contains one of the strings. It
9254 can be used to detect particular patterns in query strings for example. See
9255 also "path_sub" and other "urlp_" criteria.
9256
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +02009257urlp_val(<name>) <integer>
9258 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" starts with a number matching
9259 the values or ranges specified. Note that the absence of the parameter does
9260 not match anything. Integers are unsigned so it is not possible to match
9261 negative data.
9262
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01009263
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020092647.6. Pre-defined ACLs
9265---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009266
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009267Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
9268every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02009269order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009270
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009271ACL name Equivalent to Usage
9272---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009273FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +02009274HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009275HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
9276HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009277HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
9278HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
9279HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
9280HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
9281LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009282METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
9283METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
9284METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
9285METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
9286METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
9287METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02009288RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009289REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009290TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009291WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
9292---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009293
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009294
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020092957.7. Using ACLs to form conditions
9296----------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009297
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009298Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
9299combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009300
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009301 - AND (implicit)
9302 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
9303 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009304
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009305A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009306
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009307 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009308
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009309Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
9310indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009311
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009312For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
9313"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
9314requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
9315is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009316
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009317 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
9318 block if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
9319 block if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
9320 block unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009321
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009322To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
9323and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009324
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009325 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
9326 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
9327 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
9328 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009329
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009330 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static urls
9331 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
9332 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
9333 use_backend www if host_www
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009334
Willy Tarreau95fa4692010-02-01 13:05:50 +01009335It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
9336expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
9337be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009338the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
Willy Tarreau95fa4692010-02-01 13:05:50 +01009339
9340 The following rule :
9341
9342 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
9343 block if METH_POST missing_cl
9344
9345 Can also be written that way :
9346
9347 block if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
9348
9349It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
9350to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
9351simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
9352sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
9353good use is the following :
9354
9355 With named ACLs :
9356
9357 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
9358 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
9359 monitor fail if site_dead
9360
9361 With anonymous ACLs :
9362
9363 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
9364
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009365See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "block" and "use_backend" keywords.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009366
Willy Tarreau5764b382007-11-30 17:46:49 +01009367
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010093687.8. Pattern extraction
9369-----------------------
9370
9371The stickiness features relies on pattern extraction in the request and
9372response. Sometimes the data needs to be converted first before being stored,
9373for instance converted from ASCII to IP or upper case to lower case.
9374
9375All these operations of data extraction and conversion are defined as
9376"pattern extraction rules". A pattern rule always has the same format. It
9377begins with a single pattern fetch word, potentially followed by a list of
9378arguments within parenthesis then an optional list of transformations. As
9379much as possible, the pattern fetch functions use the same name as their
9380equivalent used in ACLs.
9381
9382The list of currently supported pattern fetch functions is the following :
9383
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +02009384 base This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the
9385 path part of the request, which starts at the first slash and
9386 ends before the question mark. It can be useful in virtual
9387 hosted environments to detect URL abuses as well as to improve
9388 shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size stick
9389 table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
9390 requested objects by host/path.
9391
Willy Tarreauab1f7b72012-12-09 13:38:54 +01009392 base32 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base"
9393 fetch method above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on
9394 high traffic sites without having to store all URLs. Instead a
9395 shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
9396 is an unsigned integer.
9397
Willy Tarreau4a550602012-12-09 14:53:32 +01009398 base32+src This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the
9399 src fetch below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a
9400 size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on the source address family.
9401 This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
9402
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009403 src This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session.
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01009404 It is of type IPv4 and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
9405 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent,
9406 according to RFC 4291.
9407
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009408 dst This is the destination IPv4 address of the session on the
9409 client side, which is the address the client connected to.
9410 It can be useful when running in transparent mode. It is of
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01009411 type IPv4 and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
9412 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent,
9413 according to RFC 4291.
9414
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009415 dst_port This is the destination TCP port of the session on the client
9416 side, which is the port the client connected to. This might be
9417 used when running in transparent mode or when assigning dynamic
9418 ports to some clients for a whole application session. It is of
9419 type integer and only works with such tables.
9420
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02009421 hdr(<name>[,<occ>])
9422 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP
9423 request. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as
9424 a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
9425 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
9426 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the
9427 last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header once
Willy Tarreaue428fb72011-12-16 21:50:30 +01009428 converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table.
Willy Tarreau4a568972010-05-12 08:08:50 +02009429
Willy Tarreau6812bcf2012-04-29 09:28:50 +02009430 path This extracts the request's URL path (without the host part). A
9431 typical use is with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals
9432 which need to aggregate multiple information from databases and
9433 keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing caches, it would be
9434 wiser to use "url" instead.
9435
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02009436 payload(<offset>,<length>)
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009437 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes, and starting
9438 at bytes <offset> in the buffer of request or response (request
9439 on "stick on" or "stick match" or response in on "stick store
9440 response").
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009441
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02009442 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>])
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009443 This extracts a binary block. In a first step the size of the
9444 block is read from response or request buffer at <offset>
9445 bytes and considered coded on <length> bytes. In a second step
9446 data of the block are read from buffer at <offset2> bytes
9447 (by default <lengthoffset> + <lengthsize>).
9448 If <offset2> is prefixed by '+' or '-', it is relative to
9449 <lengthoffset> + <lengthsize> else it is absolute.
9450 Ex: see SSL session id example in "stick table" chapter.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009451
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +02009452 src_port This is the source TCP port of the session on the client side,
9453 which is the port the client connected from. It is very unlikely
9454 that this function will be useful but it's available at no cost.
9455 It is of type integer and only works with such tables.
9456
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009457 ssl_c_ca_err Returns the ID of the first error detected during verify of the
9458 client certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was detected.
9459
9460 ssl_c_ca_err_depth
9461 Returns the depth of the first error detected during verify. If
9462 no error is encountered in the CA chain, zero is returned.
9463
9464 ssl_c_err Returns the ID of the first error detected during verify of the
9465 client certificate at depth == 0, or 0 if no errors.
9466
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02009467 ssl_c_i_dn[(entry[,occ])]
9468 If no entry specified, returns the full distinguished name of
9469 the issuer of the certificate presented by the client when
9470 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
9471 layer. Otherwise returns the the value of the first given entry
9472 found from the the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
9473 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument,
9474 it returns the value of the nth given entry found from the
9475 beginning/end of the DN. For instance to retrieve the common
9476 name ssl_c_i_dn(CN) and the second organization unit
9477 ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2).
9478
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +02009479 ssl_c_key_alg
9480 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of
9481 the certificate presented by the client when the incoming
9482 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9483
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +02009484 ssl_c_notafter
9485 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted
9486 string YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made
9487 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9488
9489 ssl_c_notbefore
9490 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted
9491 string YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made
9492 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9493
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02009494 ssl_c_s_dn[(entry[,occ])]
9495 If no entry specified, returns the full distinguished name of
9496 the subject of the certificate presented by the client when
9497 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
9498 layer. Otherwise returns the the value of the first given entry
9499 found from the the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
9500 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument,
9501 it returns the value of the nth given entry found from the
9502 beginning/end of the DN. For instance to retrieve the common
9503 name ssl_c_s_dn(CN) and the second organization unit
9504 ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2).
9505
Willy Tarreau8d598402012-10-22 17:58:39 +02009506 ssl_c_serial Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client
9507 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
9508 layer.
9509
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +02009510 ssl_c_sig_alg
9511 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate
9512 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made
9513 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9514
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +01009515 ssl_c_used
9516 Returns 1 if current SSL session use a client certificate,
9517 otherwise 0. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
9518
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009519 ssl_c_verify Returns the verify result errorID when the incoming connection
9520 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no
9521 error is encountered.
9522
Emeric Bruna7359fd2012-10-17 15:03:11 +02009523 ssl_c_version
9524 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client
9525 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
9526 layer.
9527
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02009528 ssl_f_i_dn[(entry[,occ])]
9529 If no entry specified, returns the full distinguished name of
9530 the issuer of the certificate presented by the frontend when
9531 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
9532 layer. Otherwise returns the the value of the first given entry
9533 found from the the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
9534 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument,
9535 it returns the value of the nth given entry found from the
9536 beginning/end of the DN. For instance to retrieve the common
9537 name ssl_f_i_dn(CN) and the second organization unit
9538 ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2).
9539
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +02009540 ssl_f_key_alg
9541 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of
9542 the certificate presented by the frontend when the incoming
9543 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9544
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +02009545 ssl_f_notafter
9546 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted
9547 string YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made
9548 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9549
9550 ssl_f_notbefore
9551 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted
9552 string YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made
9553 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9554
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02009555 ssl_f_s_dn[(entry[,occ])]
9556 If no entry specified, returns the full distinguished name of
9557 the subject of the certificate presented by the frontend when
9558 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
9559 layer. Otherwise returns the the value of the first given entry
9560 found from the the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
9561 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument,
9562 it returns the value of the nth given entry found from the
9563 beginning/end of the DN. For instance to retrieve the common
9564 name ssl_f_s_dn(CN) and the second organization unit
9565 ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2).
9566
Willy Tarreau8d598402012-10-22 17:58:39 +02009567 ssl_f_serial Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend
9568 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
9569 layer.
9570
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +02009571 ssl_f_sig_alg
9572 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate
9573 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made
9574 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9575
Emeric Bruna7359fd2012-10-17 15:03:11 +02009576 ssl_f_version
9577 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend
9578 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
9579 layer.
9580
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009581 ssl_fc This checks the transport layer used on the front connection,
9582 and returns 1 if it was made via an SSL/TLS transport layer,
9583 otherwise zero.
9584
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +02009585 ssl_fc_alg_keysize
9586 Returns the symmetric cipher key size support d in bits when the
9587 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9588
9589 ssl_fc_cipher
9590 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection
9591 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9592
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009593 ssl_fc_has_crt
9594 Returns 1 if a client certificate is present in the front
9595 connection over SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise 0.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +01009596 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket,
9597 client certificate is not present in the current connection but
9598 may be retrieved from the cache or the ticket. So prefer
9599 "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if current SSL session uses
9600 a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009601
9602 ssl_fc_has_sni
9603 This checks the transport layer used by the front connection, and
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02009604 returns 1 if the connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
9605 layer and the client sent a Server Name Indication TLS extension,
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02009606 otherwise zero. This requires that the SSL library is build with
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02009607 support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02009608
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009609 ssl_fc_npn This extracts the Next Protocol Negociation field from an
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +02009610 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and
9611 locally deciphered by haproxy. The result is a string containing
9612 the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL library must
9613 have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009614 haproxy -vv). See also the "npn" bind keyword.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +02009615
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +02009616 ssl_fc_protocol
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01009617 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming
9618 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +02009619
Emeric Brunfe68f682012-10-16 14:59:28 +02009620 ssl_fc_session_id
9621 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming
9622 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful to
9623 stick on a given client.
9624
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009625 ssl_fc_sni This extracts the Server Name Indication field from an incoming
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02009626 connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
9627 deciphered by haproxy. The result typically is a string matching
9628 the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must
9629 have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
9630 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02009631
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +02009632 ssl_fc_use_keysize
9633 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the
9634 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9635
Willy Tarreau6812bcf2012-04-29 09:28:50 +02009636 url This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A
9637 typical use is with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals
9638 which need to aggregate multiple information from databases and
9639 keep them in caches. See also "path".
9640
9641 url_ip This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the
9642 host part is presented as an IP address. Its use is very
9643 limited. For instance, a monitoring system might use this field
9644 as an alternative for the source IP in order to test what path a
9645 given source address would follow, or to force an entry in a
9646 table for a given source address.
9647
9648 url_port This extracts the port part from the request's URL. It probably
9649 is totally useless but it was available at no cost.
9650
bedis4c75cca2012-10-05 08:38:24 +02009651 url_param(<name>[,<delim>])
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009652 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in
bedis4c75cca2012-10-05 08:38:24 +02009653 the parameter string of the request and uses the corresponding
9654 value to match. Optionally, a delimiter can be provided. If not
9655 then the question mark '?' is used by default.
9656 A typical use is to get sticky session through url for cases
9657 where cookies cannot be used.
9658
9659 Example :
9660 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
9661 stick on url_param(PHPSESSIONID)
9662 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
9663 stick on url_param(JSESSIONID,;)
David Cournapeau16023ee2010-12-23 20:55:41 +09009664
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02009665 rdp_cookie(<name>)
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009666 This extracts the value of the rdp cookie <name> as a string
9667 and uses this value to match. This enables implementation of
9668 persistence based on the mstshash cookie. This is typically
9669 done if there is no msts cookie present.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09009670
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009671 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing
9672 algorithm may be used and thus the distribution of clients
9673 to backend servers is not linked to a hash of the RDP
9674 cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
9675 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconnect" will
9676 lead to a more even distribution of clients to backend
9677 servers than the hash used by "balance rdp-cookie".
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09009678
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009679 Example :
9680 listen tse-farm
9681 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
9682 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
9683 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
9684 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
9685 # apply RDP cookie persistence
9686 persist rdp-cookie
9687 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
9688 # This is only useful makes sense if
9689 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
9690 stick-table type string size 204800
9691 stick on rdp_cookie(mstshash)
9692 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
9693 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09009694
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009695 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie",
9696 "tcp-request" and the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09009697
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02009698 cookie(<name>)
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009699 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a
Willy Tarreau28376d62012-04-26 21:26:10 +02009700 "Cookie" header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header
9701 from the response, and uses the corresponding value to match. A
9702 typical use is to get multiple clients sharing a same profile
9703 use the same server. This can be similar to what "appsession"
9704 does with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
9705 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Willy Tarreaub3eb2212011-07-01 16:16:17 +02009706
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009707 See also : "appsession"
Willy Tarreaub3eb2212011-07-01 16:16:17 +02009708
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02009709 set-cookie(<name>)
Willy Tarreau28376d62012-04-26 21:26:10 +02009710 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the
9711 "cookie" fetch which is capable of handling both requests and
9712 responses. This keyword will disappear soon.
9713
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009714 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a
9715 "Set-Cookie" header line from the response and uses the
9716 corresponding value to match. This can be comparable to what
9717 "appsession" does with default options, but with support for
9718 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Willy Tarreaub3eb2212011-07-01 16:16:17 +02009719
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009720 See also : "appsession"
Willy Tarreaub3eb2212011-07-01 16:16:17 +02009721
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09009722
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009723The currently available list of transformations include :
9724
9725 lower Convert a string pattern to lower case. This can only be placed
9726 after a string pattern fetch function or after a conversion
9727 function returning a string type. The result is of type string.
9728
9729 upper Convert a string pattern to upper case. This can only be placed
9730 after a string pattern fetch function or after a conversion
9731 function returning a string type. The result is of type string.
9732
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02009733 ipmask(<mask>) Apply a mask to an IPv4 address, and use the result for lookups
Willy Tarreaud31d6eb2010-01-26 18:01:41 +01009734 and storage. This can be used to make all hosts within a
9735 certain mask to share the same table entries and as such use
9736 the same server. The mask can be passed in dotted form (eg:
9737 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (eg: 24).
9738
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009739
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020097408. Logging
9741----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009742
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009743One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
9744provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
9745very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
9746provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
9747state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009748to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009749headers.
9750
9751In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
9752about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
9753send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
9754
9755 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
9756 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
9757 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
9758 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
9759 at the termination.
9760
9761The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
9762allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
9763as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
9764while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
9765real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
9766delay.
9767
9768
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020097698.1. Log levels
9770---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009771
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +09009772TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009773source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +09009774HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
9775in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
9776track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
9777syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
9778about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009779
9780
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020097818.2. Log formats
9782----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009783
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01009784HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +09009785and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
9786slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
9787options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009788
9789 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
9790 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
9791 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
9792 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
9793 extents.
9794
9795 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
9796 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
9797 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
9798 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
9799 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
9800
9801 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
9802 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
9803 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
9804 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
9805 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
9806
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02009807 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
9808 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
9809 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
9810 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
9811
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01009812 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
9813
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009814Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
9815specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
9816field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
9817servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
9818always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
9819identifier.
9820
9821Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
9822 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
9823 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
9824 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
9825 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
9826
9827
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020098288.2.1. Default log format
9829-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009830
9831This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
9832as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
9833format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
9834
9835 Example :
9836 listen www
9837 mode http
9838 log global
9839 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
9840
9841 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
9842 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
9843 (www/HTTP)
9844
9845 Field Format Extract from the example above
9846 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
9847 2 'Connect from' Connect from
9848 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
9849 4 'to' to
9850 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
9851 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
9852
9853Detailed fields description :
9854 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
9855 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
9856 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
9857 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
9858 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
9859 and processed the connection.
9860 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
9861
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01009862In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
9863"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
9864connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
9865
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009866It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
9867will eventually disappear.
9868
9869
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020098708.2.2. TCP log format
9871---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009872
9873The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
9874is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
9875information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
9876counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
9877emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
9878environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
9879the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
9880sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009881specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
9882not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
9883fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
9884marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009885
9886 Example :
9887 frontend fnt
9888 mode tcp
9889 option tcplog
9890 log global
9891 default_backend bck
9892
9893 backend bck
9894 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
9895
9896 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
9897 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
9898 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
9899
9900 Field Format Extract from the example above
9901 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
9902 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
9903 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
9904 4 frontend_name fnt
9905 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
9906 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
9907 7 bytes_read* 212
9908 8 termination_state --
9909 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
9910 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
9911
9912Detailed fields description :
9913 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01009914 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
9915 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
9916 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
9917 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
9918 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009919
9920 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01009921 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
9922 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
9923 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009924
9925 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
9926 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
9927 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
9928 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log.
9929
9930 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
9931 and processed the connection.
9932
9933 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
9934 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
9935 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
9936 applications.
9937
9938 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
9939 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
9940 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
9941 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
9942 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
9943
9944 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
9945 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
9946 See "Timers" below for more details.
9947
9948 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
9949 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
9950 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
9951 "Timers" below for more details.
9952
9953 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
9954 last close. It covers all possible processings. There is one exception, if
9955 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
9956 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
9957 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
9958 details.
9959
9960 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
9961 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
9962 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
9963 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
9964 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
9965
9966 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
9967 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
9968 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
9969 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
9970 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
9971 for more details.
9972
9973 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009974 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009975 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
9976 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
9977 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009978 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009979
9980 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
9981 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
9982 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
9983 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
9984 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
9985 caused by a denial of service attack.
9986
9987 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
9988 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
9989 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
9990 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
9991 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
9992 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
9993 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
9994 denial of service attack.
9995
9996 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
9997 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
9998 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
9999 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
10000 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
10001 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
10002 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
10003 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
10004 be processed than on other servers.
10005
10006 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
10007 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
10008 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
10009 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
10010 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
10011 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
10012 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
10013 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
10014 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
10015 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
10016 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
10017 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
10018 should not be attributed to the logged server.
10019
10020 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
10021 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
10022 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
10023 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
10024 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
10025 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
10026 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
10027 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
10028
10029 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
10030 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
10031 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
10032 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
10033 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
10034 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
10035 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
10036 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
10037 occurs.
10038
10039
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200100408.2.3. HTTP log format
10041----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010042
10043The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
10044is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
10045the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
10046are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
10047emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
10048generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
10049"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
10050which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020010051frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
10052is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010053
10054Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
10055slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
10056with a star ('*') after the field name below.
10057
10058 Example :
10059 frontend http-in
10060 mode http
10061 option httplog
10062 log global
10063 default_backend bck
10064
10065 backend static
10066 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
10067
10068 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
10069 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
10070 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010071 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010072
10073 Field Format Extract from the example above
10074 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
10075 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
10076 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
10077 4 frontend_name http-in
10078 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
10079 6 Tq '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Tt* 10/0/30/69/109
10080 7 status_code 200
10081 8 bytes_read* 2750
10082 9 captured_request_cookie -
10083 10 captured_response_cookie -
10084 11 termination_state ----
10085 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
10086 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
10087 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
10088 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
10089 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010090
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010091
10092Detailed fields description :
10093 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010010094 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
10095 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
10096 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
10097 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
10098 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010099
10100 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010010101 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
10102 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
10103 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010104
10105 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the TCP connection was received by
10106 haproxy (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on
10107 the network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is
10108 usually the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. This
10109 does not depend on the fact that the client has sent the request or not.
10110
10111 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
10112 and processed the connection.
10113
10114 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
10115 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
10116 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
10117
10118 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
10119 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
10120 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
10121 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
10122 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
10123 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
10124
10125 - "Tq" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the client to send
10126 a full HTTP request, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the connection
10127 was aborted before a complete request could be received. It should always
10128 be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet. Large
10129 times here generally indicate network trouble between the client and
10130 haproxy. See "Timers" below for more details.
10131
10132 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
10133 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
10134 See "Timers" below for more details.
10135
10136 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
10137 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
10138 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See "Timers"
10139 below for more details.
10140
10141 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
10142 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
10143 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
10144 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
10145 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
10146 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See "Timers" below
10147 for more details.
10148
10149 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
10150 last close. It covers all possible processings. There is one exception, if
10151 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
10152 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
10153 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
10154 details.
10155
10156 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
10157 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
10158 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
10159
10160 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
10161 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
10162 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
10163 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
10164 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
10165 overflowing.
10166
10167 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
10168 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
10169 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
10170 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
10171 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
10172 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
10173 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
10174 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
10175
10176 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
10177 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
10178 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
10179 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
10180 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
10181 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
10182 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
10183 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
10184
10185 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
10186 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
10187 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
10188 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
10189 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
10190 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
10191 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
10192
10193 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010194 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010195 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
10196 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
10197 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010198 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010199 system.
10200
10201 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
10202 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
10203 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
10204 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
10205 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
10206 caused by a denial of service attack.
10207
10208 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
10209 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
10210 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
10211 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
10212 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
10213 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
10214 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
10215 denial of service attack.
10216
10217 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
10218 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
10219 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
10220 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
10221 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
10222 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
10223 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
10224 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
10225 processed than on other servers.
10226
10227 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
10228 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
10229 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
10230 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
10231 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
10232 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
10233 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
10234 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
10235 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
10236 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
10237 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
10238 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
10239 should not be attributed to the logged server.
10240
10241 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
10242 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
10243 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
10244 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
10245 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
10246 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
10247 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
10248 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
10249
10250 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
10251 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
10252 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
10253 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
10254 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
10255 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
10256 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
10257 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
10258 occurs.
10259
10260 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
10261 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
10262 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
10263 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
10264 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
10265 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
10266 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
10267 cookies" below for more details.
10268
10269 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
10270 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
10271 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
10272 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
10273 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
10274 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
10275 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
10276 and cookies" below for more details.
10277
10278 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
10279 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
10280 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
10281 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
10282 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
10283 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
10284 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
10285 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
10286
10287
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200102888.2.4. Custom log format
10289------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010290
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010010291The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010292mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010293
10294HAproxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
10295Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
10296separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
10297prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
10298
10299Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
10300variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
10301string formats ("Q").
10302
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010010303If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
10304as a pattern extraction rule (see section 7.8). This it useful to add some
10305less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
10306the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
10307
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010308Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
10309HAproxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
10310
10311Flags are :
10312 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010313 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010314
10315 Example:
10316
10317 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
10318 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
10319
10320At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
10321
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010010322 log-format %ci:%cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tq/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Tt\ %ST\ %B\ %CC\ \
10323 %CS\ %tsc\ %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq\ %hr\ %hs\ %{+Q}r
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010324
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010325the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010326
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010010327 log-format %{+Q}o\ %{-Q}ci\ -\ -\ [%T]\ %r\ %ST\ %B\ \"\"\ \"\"\ %cp\ \
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020010328 %ms\ %ft\ %b\ %s\ \%Tq\ %Tw\ %Tc\ %Tr\ %Tt\ %tsc\ %ac\ %fc\ \
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010010329 %bc\ %sc\ %rc\ %sq\ %bq\ %CC\ %CS\ \%hrl\ %hsl
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010330
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010331and the default TCP format is defined this way :
10332
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010010333 log-format %ci:%cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tw/%Tc/%Tt\ %B\ %ts\ \
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010334 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq
10335
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010336Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
10337
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010338 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020010339 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010340 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
10341 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
10342 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010010343 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
10344 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
10345 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020010346 | | %H | hostname | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010347 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010010348 | H | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020010349 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010350 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080010351 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020010352 | H | %Tq | Tq | numeric |
10353 | H | %Tr | Tr | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020010354 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010355 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
10356 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010010357 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010358 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
10359 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010010360 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
10361 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
10362 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010363 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010010364 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
10365 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010366 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010010367 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
10368 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
10369 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020010370 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020010371 | H | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
10372 | H | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
10373 | H | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
10374 | H | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010375 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020010376 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020010377 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010378 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010010379 | H | %rt | http_request_counter | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010380 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010010381 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
10382 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
10383 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010384 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020010385 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
10386 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010010387 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010388 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020010389 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010390 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010391
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020010392 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010393
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010010394
103958.2.5. Error log format
10396-----------------------
10397
10398When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
10399protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
10400By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
10401"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
10402will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (eg: probes) are not
10403logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
10404
10405The format looks like this :
10406
10407 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
10408 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
10409 Connection error during SSL handshake
10410
10411 Field Format Extract from the example above
10412 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
10413 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
10414 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
10415 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
10416 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
10417
10418These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
10419failures.
10420
10421
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200104228.3. Advanced logging options
10423-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010424
10425Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
10426just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
10427options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
10428for more information about their usage.
10429
10430
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200104318.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
10432------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010433
10434It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
10435haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
10436commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
10437monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
10438ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
10439
10440 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
10441 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
10442 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
10443 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
10444
10445 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
10446 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
10447 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
10448 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipments
10449 such as other load-balancers.
10450
10451 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
10452 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
10453 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
10454
10455
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200104568.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
10457----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010458
10459The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
10460what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
10461or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
10462"option logasap" in the frontend. Haproxy will then log as soon as possible,
10463just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
10464log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
10465after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
10466is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
10467with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
10468with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
10469
10470
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200104718.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
10472------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020010473
10474Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
10475for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
10476"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
10477retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
10478raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
10479a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
10480file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
10481you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
10482"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
10483
10484
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200104858.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
10486--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020010487
10488Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
10489multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
10490them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
10491"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
10492logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
10493error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
10494and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
10495too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
10496useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
10497alternative.
10498
10499
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200105008.4. Timing events
10501------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010502
10503Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
10504reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
10505the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
10506frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
10507mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/Tt" :
10508
10509 - Tq: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
10510 elapsed between the moment the client connection was accepted and the
10511 moment the proxy received the last HTTP header. The value "-1" indicates
10512 that the end of headers (empty line) has never been seen. This happens when
10513 the client closes prematurely or times out.
10514
10515 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
10516 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
10517 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
10518 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
10519 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
10520
10521 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
10522 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
10523 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
10524 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
10525 connection never established.
10526
10527 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
10528 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
10529 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
10530 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
10531 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
10532 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
10533 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
10534 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
10535 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
10536 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
10537 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
10538
10539 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
10540 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
10541 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Tq+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
10542 prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
10543 transmission time, by substracting other timers when valid :
10544
10545 Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr)
10546
10547 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
10548 mode, "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never be
10549 negative.
10550
10551These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
10552protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
10553that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010554due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Tt" is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010555close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means that a
10556session has been aborted on timeout.
10557
10558Most common cases :
10559
10560 - If "Tq" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
10561 client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might happen
10562 when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It may
10563 happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network cause.
10564 Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has ended,
10565 haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds. The time
10566 spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay processing
10567 of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the order of
10568 a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of new
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020010569 connections have been accepted at once. Setting "option http-server-close"
10570 may display larger request times since "Tq" also measures the time spent
10571 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010572
10573 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
10574 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
10575 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
10576 of ms on remote networks.
10577
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010578 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
10579 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
10580 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010581
10582 - If "Tt" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
10583 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection, for
10584 instance because both have agreed on a keep-alive connection mode. In order
10585 to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify "option httpclose" on
10586 either the frontend or the backend. If the problem persists, it means that
10587 the server ignores the "close" connection mode and expects the client to
10588 close. Then it will be required to use "option forceclose". Having the
10589 smallest possible 'Tt' is important when connection regulation is used with
10590 the "maxconn" option on the servers, since no new connection will be sent
10591 to the server until another one is released.
10592
10593Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
10594
10595 Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Tt The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
10596 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
10597 except "Tt" which is shorter than reality.
10598
10599 -1/xx/xx/xx/Tt The client was not able to send a complete request in time
10600 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
10601 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
10602
10603 Tq/-1/xx/xx/Tt It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
10604 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
10605 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
10606 flags.
10607
10608 Tq/Tw/-1/xx/Tt The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
10609 actively refused it or it timed out after Tt-(Tq+Tw) ms.
10610 Check the session termination flags, then check the
10611 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
10612 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
10613 the client connection was maintained open.
10614
10615 Tq/Tw/Tc/-1/Tt The server has accepted the connection but did not return
10616 a complete response in time, or it closed its connexion
10617 unexpectedly after Tt-(Tq+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
10618 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
10619
10620
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200106218.5. Session state at disconnection
10622-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010623
10624TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
10625"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
106262-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
10627each of which has a special meaning :
10628
10629 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
10630 session to terminate :
10631
10632 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
10633
10634 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
10635 server explicitly refused it.
10636
10637 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
10638 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
10639 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
10640 error in server response which might have caused information leak
10641 (eg: cacheable cookie), or because the response was processed by
10642 the proxy (redirect, stats, etc...).
10643
10644 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
10645 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
10646 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
10647 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
10648 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
10649
10650 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
10651 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
10652 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
10653 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
10654 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
10655
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090010656 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
10657 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
10658
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070010659 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
10660 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
10661 backup connections when going up.
10662
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020010663 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
10664
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010665 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
10666 send or receive data.
10667
10668 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
10669 send or receive data.
10670
10671 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
10672 with nothing left in the buffers.
10673
10674 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
10675
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010010676 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010677 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
10678
10679 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
10680 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
10681 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
10682 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
10683 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
10684
10685 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
10686 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
10687
10688 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
10689 server (HTTP only).
10690
10691 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
10692
10693 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
10694 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
10695 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
10696
10697 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
10698 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
10699 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
10700
10701 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
10702
10703 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
10704 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
10705
10706 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
10707 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
10708 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
10709
10710 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
10711 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020010712 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
10713 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010714
10715 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
10716 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
10717 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
10718 another server.
10719
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020010720 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010721 server.
10722
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020010723 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
10724 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
10725 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
10726 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
10727
10728 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
10729 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
10730 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
10731 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
10732
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020010733 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
10734 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
10735 "use-server" rule).
10736
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010737 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
10738
10739 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
10740 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
10741
10742 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
10743
10744 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
10745 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
10746 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
10747
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020010748 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
10749 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
10750 happens everytime there is activity at a different date than the
10751 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
10752 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
10753
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010754 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
10755
10756 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
10757 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
10758
10759 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
10760
10761 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
10762
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020010763The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
10764was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010765helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
10766starvation, attacks, etc...
10767
10768The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
10769alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
10770easier finding and understanding.
10771
10772 Flags Reason
10773
10774 -- Normal termination.
10775
10776 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
10777 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
10778 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
10779 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
10780
10781 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
10782 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
10783 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
10784 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
10785 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
10786 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010787
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010788 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
10789 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010790 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010791
10792 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
10793 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
10794 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
10795
10796 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
10797 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
10798 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
10799 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
10800 the server takes too long to respond.
10801
10802 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
10803 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
10804 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
10805 long a time to respond.
10806
10807 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
10808 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
10809 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
10810 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
10811 and the client.
10812
10813 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
10814 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
10815 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
10816 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
10817 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
10818 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here.
10819
10820 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
10821 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010822 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
10823 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
10824 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
10825 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010826
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010827 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010828 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
10829 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
10830 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (eg: no route,
10831 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
10832 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
10833
10834 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
10835 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
10836 503 or 504 here.
10837
10838 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
10839 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
10840 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
10841 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
10842 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
10843
10844 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
10845 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010846 by too short timeouts on L4 equipments before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010847 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
10848 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
10849
10850 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
10851 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
10852 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
10853 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
10854 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
10855 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
10856 between haproxy and the server.
10857
10858 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
10859 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
10860 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
10861 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
10862 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
10863 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
10864 solution is to fix the application.
10865
10866 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
10867 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
10868 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
10869 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
10870 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
10871 external attacks.
10872
10873 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
10874 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010875 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010876 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
10877 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
10878
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010010879 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
10880 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
10881 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
10882 the client.
10883
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010884 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
10885 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
10886 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
10887 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010010888 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
10889 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
10890 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
10891 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
10892 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010893
10894 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
10895 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
10896 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
10897 returned an HTTP 403 error.
10898
10899 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
10900 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
10901 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
10902 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
10903
10904 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
10905 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
10906 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
10907 only be solved by proper system tuning.
10908
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020010909The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
10910persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
10911important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
10912re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
10913
10914 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
10915
10916 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
10917 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
10918 set on a GET request.
10919
10920 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
10921 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010922 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020010923 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
10924
10925 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
10926 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
10927 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
10928
10929 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
10930 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
10931 already got a cookie.
10932
10933 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
10934 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
10935 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
10936 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
10937 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
10938
10939 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
10940 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
10941 new cookie was inserted in the response.
10942
10943 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
10944 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
10945 new cookie was inserted in the response.
10946
10947 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
10948 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
10949
10950 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
10951 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
10952 then advertised in the response.
10953
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010954
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200109558.6. Non-printable characters
10956-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010957
10958In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
10959consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
10960converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
10961prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
10962being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
10963escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
10964is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
10965'}' when logging headers.
10966
10967Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
10968issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
10969containing spaces is "User-Agent".
10970
10971Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
10972the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
10973performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
10974
10975
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200109768.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
10977---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010978
10979Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
10980achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010981section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010982cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
10983the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
10984the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010985locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010986not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
10987user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
10988a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
10989wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
10990
10991 Examples :
10992 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
10993 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
10994
10995 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
10996 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
10997
10998
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200109998.8. Capturing HTTP headers
11000---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011001
11002Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
11003proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
11004the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
11005server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
11006
11007Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
11008response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011009section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011010
11011It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011012time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
11013appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011014are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
11015and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
11016follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
11017request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
11018in the logs.
11019
11020 Example :
11021 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
11022 listen proxy-out
11023 mode http
11024 option httplog
11025 option logasap
11026 log global
11027 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
11028
11029 # log the name of the virtual server
11030 capture request header Host len 20
11031
11032 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
11033 capture request header Content-Length len 10
11034
11035 # log the beginning of the referrer
11036 capture request header Referer len 20
11037
11038 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
11039 capture response header Server len 20
11040
11041 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
11042 capture response header Content-Length len 10
11043
11044 # log the expected cache behaviour on the response
11045 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
11046
11047 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
11048 capture response header Via len 20
11049
11050 # log the URL location during a redirection
11051 capture response header Location len 20
11052
11053 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
11054 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
11055 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
11056 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
11057 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
11058
11059 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
11060 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
11061 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
11062 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011063 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011064
11065 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
11066 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
11067 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
11068 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
11069 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011070 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011071
11072
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200110738.9. Examples of logs
11074---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011075
11076These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
11077them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
11078reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
11079
11080 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
11081 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
11082 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
11083
11084 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
11085 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
11086
11087 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
11088 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
11089 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
11090
11091 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
11092 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
11093
11094 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
11095 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
11096 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
11097
11098 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011099 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011100 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
11101 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
11102
11103 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
11104 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
11105 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
11106
11107 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
11108 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020011109 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011110 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
11111 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
11112 to return the 502 and not the server.
11113
11114 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011115 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011116
11117 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
11118 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
11119 Nothing was sent to any server.
11120
11121 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
11122 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
11123
11124 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
11125 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
11126 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
11127 send a 408 return code to the client.
11128
11129 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
11130 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
11131
11132 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
11133 5 seconds ("c----").
11134
11135 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
11136 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011137 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011138
11139 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011140 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011141 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
11142 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
11143 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
11144 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
11145 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011146
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010011147
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200111489. Statistics and monitoring
11149----------------------------
11150
11151It is possible to query HAProxy about its status. The most commonly used
11152mechanism is the HTTP statistics page. This page also exposes an alternative
11153CSV output format for monitoring tools. The same format is provided on the
11154Unix socket.
11155
11156
111579.1. CSV format
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010011158---------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010011159
Willy Tarreau7f062c42009-03-05 18:43:00 +010011160The statistics may be consulted either from the unix socket or from the HTTP
11161page. Both means provide a CSV format whose fields follow.
11162
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010011163 0. pxname: proxy name
11164 1. svname: service name (FRONTEND for frontend, BACKEND for backend, any name
11165 for server)
11166 2. qcur: current queued requests
11167 3. qmax: max queued requests
11168 4. scur: current sessions
11169 5. smax: max sessions
11170 6. slim: sessions limit
11171 7. stot: total sessions
11172 8. bin: bytes in
11173 9. bout: bytes out
11174 10. dreq: denied requests
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010011175 11. dresp: denied responses
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010011176 12. ereq: request errors
11177 13. econ: connection errors
Willy Tarreauae526782010-03-04 20:34:23 +010011178 14. eresp: response errors (among which srv_abrt)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010011179 15. wretr: retries (warning)
11180 16. wredis: redispatches (warning)
Cyril Bonté0dae5852010-02-03 00:26:28 +010011181 17. status: status (UP/DOWN/NOLB/MAINT/MAINT(via)...)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010011182 18. weight: server weight (server), total weight (backend)
11183 19. act: server is active (server), number of active servers (backend)
11184 20. bck: server is backup (server), number of backup servers (backend)
11185 21. chkfail: number of failed checks
11186 22. chkdown: number of UP->DOWN transitions
11187 23. lastchg: last status change (in seconds)
11188 24. downtime: total downtime (in seconds)
11189 25. qlimit: queue limit
11190 26. pid: process id (0 for first instance, 1 for second, ...)
11191 27. iid: unique proxy id
11192 28. sid: service id (unique inside a proxy)
11193 29. throttle: warm up status
11194 30. lbtot: total number of times a server was selected
11195 31. tracked: id of proxy/server if tracking is enabled
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +020011196 32. type (0=frontend, 1=backend, 2=server, 3=socket)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkidb57c6b2009-08-31 21:23:27 +020011197 33. rate: number of sessions per second over last elapsed second
11198 34. rate_lim: limit on new sessions per second
11199 35. rate_max: max number of new sessions per second
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki09605412009-09-23 22:09:24 +020011200 36. check_status: status of last health check, one of:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010011201 UNK -> unknown
11202 INI -> initializing
11203 SOCKERR -> socket error
11204 L4OK -> check passed on layer 4, no upper layers testing enabled
11205 L4TMOUT -> layer 1-4 timeout
11206 L4CON -> layer 1-4 connection problem, for example
11207 "Connection refused" (tcp rst) or "No route to host" (icmp)
11208 L6OK -> check passed on layer 6
11209 L6TOUT -> layer 6 (SSL) timeout
11210 L6RSP -> layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
11211 L7OK -> check passed on layer 7
11212 L7OKC -> check conditionally passed on layer 7, for example 404 with
11213 disable-on-404
11214 L7TOUT -> layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
11215 L7RSP -> layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
11216 L7STS -> layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki09605412009-09-23 22:09:24 +020011217 37. check_code: layer5-7 code, if available
11218 38. check_duration: time in ms took to finish last health check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011219 39. hrsp_1xx: http responses with 1xx code
11220 40. hrsp_2xx: http responses with 2xx code
11221 41. hrsp_3xx: http responses with 3xx code
11222 42. hrsp_4xx: http responses with 4xx code
11223 43. hrsp_5xx: http responses with 5xx code
11224 44. hrsp_other: http responses with other codes (protocol error)
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011225 45. hanafail: failed health checks details
11226 46. req_rate: HTTP requests per second over last elapsed second
11227 47. req_rate_max: max number of HTTP requests per second observed
11228 48. req_tot: total number of HTTP requests received
Willy Tarreauae526782010-03-04 20:34:23 +010011229 49. cli_abrt: number of data transfers aborted by the client
11230 50. srv_abrt: number of data transfers aborted by the server (inc. in eresp)
Willy Tarreau55058a72012-11-21 08:27:21 +010011231 51. comp_in: number of HTTP response bytes fed to the compressor
11232 52. comp_out: number of HTTP response bytes emitted by the compressor
11233 53. comp_byp: number of bytes that bypassed the HTTP compressor (CPU/BW limit)
Willy Tarreau11d4ec82012-11-26 00:49:03 +010011234 54. comp_rsp: number of HTTP responses that were compressed
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011235
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010011236
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200112379.2. Unix Socket commands
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010011238-------------------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010011239
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010011240The following commands are supported on the UNIX stats socket ; all of them
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020011241must be terminated by a line feed. The socket supports pipelining, so that it
11242is possible to chain multiple commands at once provided they are delimited by
11243a semi-colon or a line feed, although the former is more reliable as it has no
11244risk of being truncated over the network. The responses themselves will each be
11245followed by an empty line, so it will be easy for an external script to match a
11246given response with a given request. By default one command line is processed
11247then the connection closes, but there is an interactive allowing multiple lines
11248to be issued one at a time.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010011249
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020011250It is important to understand that when multiple haproxy processes are started
11251on the same sockets, any process may pick up the request and will output its
11252own stats.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010011253
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011254clear counters
11255 Clear the max values of the statistics counters in each proxy (frontend &
11256 backend) and in each server. The cumulated counters are not affected. This
11257 can be used to get clean counters after an incident, without having to
11258 restart nor to clear traffic counters. This command is restricted and can
11259 only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
11260
11261clear counters all
11262 Clear all statistics counters in each proxy (frontend & backend) and in each
11263 server. This has the same effect as restarting. This command is restricted
11264 and can only be issued on sockets configured for level "admin".
11265
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090011266clear table <table> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
11267 Remove entries from the stick-table <table>.
11268
11269 This is typically used to unblock some users complaining they have been
11270 abusively denied access to a service, but this can also be used to clear some
11271 stickiness entries matching a server that is going to be replaced (see "show
11272 table" below for details). Note that sometimes, removal of an entry will be
11273 refused because it is currently tracked by a session. Retrying a few seconds
11274 later after the session ends is usual enough.
11275
11276 In the case where no options arguments are given all entries will be removed.
11277
11278 When the "data." form is used entries matching a filter applied using the
11279 stored data (see "stick-table" in section 4.2) are removed. A stored data
11280 type must be specified in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the
11281 table otherwise an error is reported. The data is compared according to
11282 <operator> with the 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with
11283 the ACLs :
11284
11285 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
11286 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
11287 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
11288 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
11289 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
11290 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
11291
11292 When the key form is used the entry <key> is removed. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090011293 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer and
11294 string.
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011295
11296 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011297 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011298 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011299 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
11300 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
11301 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
11302 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011303
11304 $ echo "clear table http_proxy key 127.0.0.1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
11305
11306 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011307 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011308 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
11309 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090011310 $ echo "clear table http_proxy data.gpc0 eq 1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
11311 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
11312 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011313
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020011314disable frontend <frontend>
11315 Mark the frontend as temporarily stopped. This corresponds to the mode which
11316 is used during a soft restart : the frontend releases the port but can be
11317 enabled again if needed. This should be used with care as some non-Linux OSes
11318 are unable to enable it back. This is intended to be used in environments
11319 where stopping a proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must
11320 be fixed. That way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another
11321 process to restore operations. The frontend will appear with status "STOP"
11322 on the stats page.
11323
11324 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
11325 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
11326
11327 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
11328 level "admin".
11329
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011330disable server <backend>/<server>
11331 Mark the server DOWN for maintenance. In this mode, no more checks will be
11332 performed on the server until it leaves maintenance.
11333 If the server is tracked by other servers, those servers will be set to DOWN
11334 during the maintenance.
11335
11336 In the statistics page, a server DOWN for maintenance will appear with a
11337 "MAINT" status, its tracking servers with the "MAINT(via)" one.
11338
11339 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020011340 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011341
11342 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
11343 level "admin".
11344
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020011345enable frontend <frontend>
11346 Resume a frontend which was temporarily stopped. It is possible that some of
11347 the listening ports won't be able to bind anymore (eg: if another process
11348 took them since the 'disable frontend' operation). If this happens, an error
11349 is displayed. Some operating systems might not be able to resume a frontend
11350 which was disabled.
11351
11352 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
11353 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
11354
11355 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
11356 level "admin".
11357
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011358enable server <backend>/<server>
11359 If the server was previously marked as DOWN for maintenance, this marks the
11360 server UP and checks are re-enabled.
11361
11362 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020011363 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011364
11365 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
11366 level "admin".
11367
11368get weight <backend>/<server>
11369 Report the current weight and the initial weight of server <server> in
11370 backend <backend> or an error if either doesn't exist. The initial weight is
11371 the one that appears in the configuration file. Both are normally equal
11372 unless the current weight has been changed. Both the backend and the server
11373 may be specified either by their name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020011374 sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011375
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020011376help
11377 Print the list of known keywords and their basic usage. The same help screen
11378 is also displayed for unknown commands.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010011379
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020011380prompt
11381 Toggle the prompt at the beginning of the line and enter or leave interactive
11382 mode. In interactive mode, the connection is not closed after a command
11383 completes. Instead, the prompt will appear again, indicating the user that
11384 the interpreter is waiting for a new command. The prompt consists in a right
11385 angle bracket followed by a space "> ". This mode is particularly convenient
11386 when one wants to periodically check information such as stats or errors.
11387 It is also a good idea to enter interactive mode before issuing a "help"
11388 command.
11389
11390quit
11391 Close the connection when in interactive mode.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010011392
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020011393set maxconn frontend <frontend> <value>
Willy Tarreau3c7a79d2012-09-26 21:07:15 +020011394 Dynamically change the specified frontend's maxconn setting. Any positive
11395 value is allowed including zero, but setting values larger than the global
11396 maxconn does not make much sense. If the limit is increased and connections
11397 were pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value
11398 below the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020011399 delayed until the threshold is reached. The frontend might be specified by
11400 either its name or its numeric ID prefixed with a sharp ('#').
11401
Willy Tarreau91886b62011-09-07 14:38:31 +020011402set maxconn global <maxconn>
11403 Dynamically change the global maxconn setting within the range defined by the
11404 initial global maxconn setting. If it is increased and connections were
11405 pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value below
11406 the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
11407 delayed until the threshold is reached. A value of zero restores the initial
11408 setting.
11409
Willy Tarreauf5b22872011-09-07 16:13:44 +020011410set rate-limit connections global <value>
11411 Change the process-wide connection rate limit, which is set by the global
11412 'maxconnrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
11413 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
11414 is passed in number of connections per second.
11415
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +010011416set rate-limit http-compression global <value>
11417 Change the maximum input compression rate, which is set by the global
11418 'maxcomprate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. The value is
William Lallemand096f5542012-11-19 17:26:05 +010011419 passed in number of kilobytes per second. The value is available in the "show
11420 info" on the line "CompressBpsRateLim" in bytes.
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +010011421
Willy Tarreau654694e2012-06-07 01:03:16 +020011422set table <table> key <key> data.<data_type> <value>
11423 Create or update a stick-table entry in the table. If the key is not present,
11424 an entry is inserted. See stick-table in section 4.2 to find all possible
11425 values for <data_type>. The most likely use consists in dynamically entering
11426 entries for source IP addresses, with a flag in gpc0 to dynamically block an
11427 IP address or affect its quality of service.
11428
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011429set timeout cli <delay>
11430 Change the CLI interface timeout for current connection. This can be useful
11431 during long debugging sessions where the user needs to constantly inspect
11432 some indicators without being disconnected. The delay is passed in seconds.
11433
11434set weight <backend>/<server> <weight>[%]
11435 Change a server's weight to the value passed in argument. If the value ends
11436 with the '%' sign, then the new weight will be relative to the initially
11437 configured weight. Relative weights are only permitted between 0 and 100%,
11438 and absolute weights are permitted between 0 and 256. Servers which are part
11439 of a farm running a static load-balancing algorithm have stricter limitations
11440 because the weight cannot change once set. Thus for these servers, the only
11441 accepted values are 0 and 100% (or 0 and the initial weight). Changes take
11442 effect immediately, though certain LB algorithms require a certain amount of
11443 requests to consider changes. A typical usage of this command is to disable
11444 a server during an update by setting its weight to zero, then to enable it
11445 again after the update by setting it back to 100%. This command is restricted
11446 and can only be issued on sockets configured for level "admin". Both the
11447 backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by their
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020011448 numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011449
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010011450show errors [<iid>]
11451 Dump last known request and response errors collected by frontends and
11452 backends. If <iid> is specified, the limit the dump to errors concerning
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020011453 either frontend or backend whose ID is <iid>. This command is restricted
11454 and can only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or
11455 "admin".
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010011456
11457 The errors which may be collected are the last request and response errors
11458 caused by protocol violations, often due to invalid characters in header
11459 names. The report precisely indicates what exact character violated the
11460 protocol. Other important information such as the exact date the error was
11461 detected, frontend and backend names, the server name (when known), the
11462 internal session ID and the source address which has initiated the session
11463 are reported too.
11464
11465 All characters are returned, and non-printable characters are encoded. The
11466 most common ones (\t = 9, \n = 10, \r = 13 and \e = 27) are encoded as one
11467 letter following a backslash. The backslash itself is encoded as '\\' to
11468 avoid confusion. Other non-printable characters are encoded '\xNN' where
11469 NN is the two-digits hexadecimal representation of the character's ASCII
11470 code.
11471
11472 Lines are prefixed with the position of their first character, starting at 0
11473 for the beginning of the buffer. At most one input line is printed per line,
11474 and large lines will be broken into multiple consecutive output lines so that
11475 the output never goes beyond 79 characters wide. It is easy to detect if a
11476 line was broken, because it will not end with '\n' and the next line's offset
11477 will be followed by a '+' sign, indicating it is a continuation of previous
11478 line.
11479
11480 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011481 $ echo "show errors" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
11482 >>> [04/Mar/2009:15:46:56.081] backend http-in (#2) : invalid response
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010011483 src 127.0.0.1, session #54, frontend fe-eth0 (#1), server s2 (#1)
11484 response length 213 bytes, error at position 23:
11485
11486 00000 HTTP/1.0 200 OK\r\n
11487 00017 header/bizarre:blah\r\n
11488 00038 Location: blah\r\n
11489 00054 Long-line: this is a very long line which should b
11490 00104+ e broken into multiple lines on the output buffer,
11491 00154+ otherwise it would be too large to print in a ter
11492 00204+ minal\r\n
11493 00211 \r\n
11494
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011495 In the example above, we see that the backend "http-in" which has internal
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010011496 ID 2 has blocked an invalid response from its server s2 which has internal
11497 ID 1. The request was on session 54 initiated by source 127.0.0.1 and
11498 received by frontend fe-eth0 whose ID is 1. The total response length was
11499 213 bytes when the error was detected, and the error was at byte 23. This
11500 is the slash ('/') in header name "header/bizarre", which is not a valid
11501 HTTP character for a header name.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010011502
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020011503show info
11504 Dump info about haproxy status on current process.
11505
11506show sess
11507 Dump all known sessions. Avoid doing this on slow connections as this can
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020011508 be huge. This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets
11509 configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
11510
Willy Tarreau66dc20a2010-03-05 17:53:32 +010011511show sess <id>
11512 Display a lot of internal information about the specified session identifier.
11513 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
11514 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). Those information are
11515 useless to most users but may be used by haproxy developers to troubleshoot a
11516 complex bug. The output format is intentionally not documented so that it can
Willy Tarreau76153662012-11-26 01:16:39 +010011517 freely evolve depending on demands. The special id "all" dumps the states of
11518 all sessions, which can be avoided as much as possible as it is highly CPU
11519 intensive and can take a lot of time.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020011520
11521show stat [<iid> <type> <sid>]
11522 Dump statistics in the CSV format. By passing <id>, <type> and <sid>, it is
11523 possible to dump only selected items :
11524 - <iid> is a proxy ID, -1 to dump everything
11525 - <type> selects the type of dumpable objects : 1 for frontends, 2 for
11526 backends, 4 for servers, -1 for everything. These values can be ORed,
11527 for example:
11528 1 + 2 = 3 -> frontend + backend.
11529 1 + 2 + 4 = 7 -> frontend + backend + server.
11530 - <sid> is a server ID, -1 to dump everything from the selected proxy.
11531
11532 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011533 $ echo "show info;show stat" | socat stdio unix-connect:/tmp/sock1
11534 >>> Name: HAProxy
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020011535 Version: 1.4-dev2-49
11536 Release_date: 2009/09/23
11537 Nbproc: 1
11538 Process_num: 1
11539 (...)
11540
11541 # pxname,svname,qcur,qmax,scur,smax,slim,stot,bin,bout,dreq, (...)
11542 stats,FRONTEND,,,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,0,,,,,OPEN,,,,,,,,,1,1,0, (...)
11543 stats,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,0,0,0,,0,250,(...)
11544 (...)
11545 www1,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,1,1,0,,0,250, (...)
11546
11547 $
11548
11549 Here, two commands have been issued at once. That way it's easy to find
11550 which process the stats apply to in multi-process mode. Notice the empty
11551 line after the information output which marks the end of the first block.
11552 A similar empty line appears at the end of the second block (stats) so that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011553 the reader knows the output has not been truncated.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020011554
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011555show table
11556 Dump general information on all known stick-tables. Their name is returned
11557 (the name of the proxy which holds them), their type (currently zero, always
11558 IP), their size in maximum possible number of entries, and the number of
11559 entries currently in use.
11560
11561 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011562 $ echo "show table" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090011563 >>> # table: front_pub, type: ip, size:204800, used:171454
11564 >>> # table: back_rdp, type: ip, size:204800, used:0
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011565
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090011566show table <name> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011567 Dump contents of stick-table <name>. In this mode, a first line of generic
11568 information about the table is reported as with "show table", then all
11569 entries are dumped. Since this can be quite heavy, it is possible to specify
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090011570 a filter in order to specify what entries to display.
11571
11572 When the "data." form is used the filter applies to the stored data (see
11573 "stick-table" in section 4.2). A stored data type must be specified
11574 in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the table otherwise an
11575 error is reported. The data is compared according to <operator> with the
11576 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with the ACLs :
11577
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011578 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
11579 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
11580 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
11581 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
11582 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
11583 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
11584
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090011585
11586 When the key form is used the entry <key> is shown. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090011587 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer,
11588 and string.
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090011589
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011590 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011591 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090011592 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011593 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
11594 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
11595 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
11596 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011597
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011598 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090011599 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011600 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
11601 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011602
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011603 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.conn_rate gt 5" | \
11604 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090011605 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011606 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
11607 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011608
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090011609 $ echo "show table http_proxy key 127.0.0.2" | \
11610 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090011611 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090011612 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
11613 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
11614
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011615 When the data criterion applies to a dynamic value dependent on time such as
11616 a bytes rate, the value is dynamically computed during the evaluation of the
11617 entry in order to decide whether it has to be dumped or not. This means that
11618 such a filter could match for some time then not match anymore because as
11619 time goes, the average event rate drops.
11620
11621 It is possible to use this to extract lists of IP addresses abusing the
11622 service, in order to monitor them or even blacklist them in a firewall.
11623 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011624 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" \
11625 | socat stdio /tmp/sock1 \
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011626 | fgrep 'key=' | cut -d' ' -f2 | cut -d= -f2 > abusers-ip.txt
11627 ( or | awk '/key/{ print a[split($2,a,"=")]; }' )
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki719e7262009-10-04 15:02:46 +020011628
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020011629shutdown frontend <frontend>
11630 Completely delete the specified frontend. All the ports it was bound to will
11631 be released. It will not be possible to enable the frontend anymore after
11632 this operation. This is intended to be used in environments where stopping a
11633 proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must be fixed. That
11634 way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another process to
11635 restore operations. The frontend will not appear at all on the stats page
11636 once it is terminated.
11637
11638 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
11639 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
11640
11641 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
11642 level "admin".
11643
Willy Tarreaua295edc2011-09-07 23:21:03 +020011644shutdown session <id>
11645 Immediately terminate the session matching the specified session identifier.
11646 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
11647 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). This can be used to
11648 terminate a long-running session without waiting for a timeout or when an
11649 endless transfer is ongoing. Such terminated sessions are reported with a 'K'
11650 flag in the logs.
11651
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020011652shutdown sessions <backend>/<server>
11653 Immediately terminate all the sessions attached to the specified server. This
11654 can be used to terminate long-running sessions after a server is put into
11655 maintenance mode, for instance. Such terminated sessions are reported with a
11656 'K' flag in the logs.
11657
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011658/*
11659 * Local variables:
11660 * fill-column: 79
11661 * End:
11662 */